* alloc.c (pure_bytes_used_lisp, pure_bytes_used_non_lisp):
[bpt/emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
22
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <signal.h>
25 #include <stdio.h>
26 #include <setjmp.h>
27
28 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
29
30 #include "lisp.h"
31 #include "blockinput.h"
32
33 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
34 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
35 #include "syssignal.h"
36
37 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
38 if this is not done before the other system files. */
39 #include "xterm.h"
40 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
41
42 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
43 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
44 #ifndef makedev
45 #include <sys/types.h>
46 #endif /* makedev */
47
48 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
49
50 #include "systime.h"
51
52 #include <fcntl.h>
53 #include <ctype.h>
54 #include <errno.h>
55 #include <setjmp.h>
56 #include <sys/stat.h>
57 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
58 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
59
60 #include "charset.h"
61 #include "character.h"
62 #include "coding.h"
63 #include "frame.h"
64 #include "dispextern.h"
65 #include "fontset.h"
66 #include "termhooks.h"
67 #include "termopts.h"
68 #include "termchar.h"
69 #include "emacs-icon.h"
70 #include "disptab.h"
71 #include "buffer.h"
72 #include "window.h"
73 #include "keyboard.h"
74 #include "intervals.h"
75 #include "process.h"
76 #include "atimer.h"
77 #include "keymap.h"
78 #include "font.h"
79 #include "fontset.h"
80 #include "xsettings.h"
81 #include "xgselect.h"
82 #include "sysselect.h"
83
84 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
85 #include <X11/Shell.h>
86 #endif
87
88 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
89 #include <sys/time.h>
90 #endif
91
92 #include <unistd.h>
93
94 #ifdef USE_GTK
95 #include "gtkutil.h"
96 #endif
97
98 #ifdef USE_LUCID
99 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
100 #endif
101
102 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
103 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
104 #define HACK_EDITRES
105 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
106 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
107
108 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
109
110 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
111 #if defined USE_MOTIF
112 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
113 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
114 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
115
116 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
117 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
118 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
119 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
120 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
121 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
122 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
123 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
124 #ifndef XtNpickTop
125 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
126 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
127 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
128 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
129
130 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
131
132 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
133 #include "widget.h"
134 #ifndef XtNinitialState
135 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
136 #endif
137 #endif
138
139 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
140 #ifdef USE_XIM
141 int use_xim = 1;
142 #else
143 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
144 #endif
145
146 \f
147
148 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
149 start. */
150
151 static int any_help_event_p;
152
153 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
154 static Lisp_Object last_window;
155
156 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
157 use. */
158
159 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
160
161 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
162 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
163 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
164 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
165
166 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
167
168 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
169 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
170 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
171 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
172
173 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
174
175 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
176
177 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
178
179 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
180
181 static struct {
182 struct frame *f;
183 int eventtype;
184 } pending_event_wait;
185
186 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
187 /* The application context for Xt use. */
188 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
189 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
190
191 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
192
193 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
194 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
195
196 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
197 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
198 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
199
200 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
201
202 /* Mouse movement.
203
204 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
205 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
206 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
207 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
208
209 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
210
211 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
212 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
213 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
214 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
215 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
216 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
217 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
218 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
219 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
220 is off. */
221
222 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
223
224 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
225 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
226 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
227
228 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
229
230 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
231 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
232 an ordinary motion.
233
234 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
235 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
236 event. */
237
238 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
239
240 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
241 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
242 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
243 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
244 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
245 it's somewhat accurate. */
246
247 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
248
249 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
250
251 static Time last_user_time;
252
253 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
254 events. */
255
256 #ifdef __STDC__
257 static int volatile input_signal_count;
258 #else
259 static int input_signal_count;
260 #endif
261
262 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
263
264 static int x_noop_count;
265
266 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
267
268 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
269 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
270
271 #ifdef USE_GTK
272 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
273 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
274
275 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
276 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
277 #endif
278
279 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
280 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
281
282 enum xembed_info
283 {
284 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
285 };
286
287 enum xembed_message
288 {
289 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
290 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
291 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
292 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
293 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
294 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
295 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
296 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
297
298 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
299 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
300 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
301 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
302 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
303 };
304
305 /* Used in x_flush. */
306
307 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
308 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
309 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
310 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
311 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
312 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
313
314 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
315 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
316 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
317 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
318 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
319 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
320 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
321 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
322 static void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int) NO_RETURN;
323 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
324 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
325 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
326 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
327 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
328 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
329 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
330 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
331 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
332 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
333 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
334 enum text_cursor_kinds);
335
336 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
337 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
338 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
339 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
340 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
341 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
342 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
343 enum scroll_bar_part *,
344 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
345 Time *);
346 static void x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
347 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
348 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
349 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
350 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
351 int *, struct input_event *);
352 #ifdef USE_GTK
353 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
354 #endif
355 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
356 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
357 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
358 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
359 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
360 static void x_initialize (void);
361
362
363 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
364
365 static void
366 x_flush (struct frame *f)
367 {
368 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
369 connection may be broken. */
370 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
371 return;
372
373 BLOCK_INPUT;
374 if (f == NULL)
375 {
376 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
377 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
378 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
379 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
380 }
381 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
382 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
383 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
384 }
385
386
387 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
388 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
389 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
390 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
391 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
392 performance. */
393
394 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
395
396 \f
397 /***********************************************************************
398 Debugging
399 ***********************************************************************/
400
401 #if 0
402
403 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
404 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
405
406 struct record
407 {
408 char *locus;
409 int type;
410 };
411
412 struct record event_record[100];
413
414 int event_record_index;
415
416 void
417 record_event (char *locus, int type)
418 {
419 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
420 event_record_index = 0;
421
422 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
423 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
424 event_record_index++;
425 }
426
427 #endif /* 0 */
428
429
430 \f
431 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
432
433 struct x_display_info *
434 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
435 {
436 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
437
438 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
439 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
440 return dpyinfo;
441
442 return 0;
443 }
444
445 static Window
446 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
447 {
448 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
449 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
450 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
451
452 while (wi != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
453 {
454 Window root;
455 Window *children;
456 unsigned int nchildren;
457
458 win = wi;
459 XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren);
460 XFree (children);
461 }
462
463 return win;
464 }
465
466 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
467
468 void
469 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
470 {
471 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
472 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
473 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
474 double alpha = 1.0;
475 double alpha_min = 1.0;
476 unsigned long opac;
477 Window parent;
478
479 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
480 alpha = f->alpha[0];
481 else
482 alpha = f->alpha[1];
483
484 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
485 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
486 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
487 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
488
489 if (alpha < 0.0)
490 return;
491 else if (alpha > 1.0)
492 alpha = 1.0;
493 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
494 alpha = alpha_min;
495
496 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
497
498 x_catch_errors (dpy);
499
500 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
501 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
502 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
503 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
504
505 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
506 if (parent != None)
507 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
508 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
509 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
510
511 /* return unless necessary */
512 {
513 unsigned char *data;
514 Atom actual;
515 int rc, format;
516 unsigned long n, left;
517
518 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
519 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
520 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
521 &data);
522
523 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
524 {
525 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
526 XFree ((void *) data);
527 if (value == opac)
528 {
529 x_uncatch_errors ();
530 return;
531 }
532 }
533 }
534
535 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
536 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
537 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
538 x_uncatch_errors ();
539 }
540
541 int
542 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
543 {
544 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
545 }
546
547 int
548 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
549 {
550 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
551 }
552
553 \f
554 /***********************************************************************
555 Starting and ending an update
556 ***********************************************************************/
557
558 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
559 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
560 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
561 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
562 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
563
564 static void
565 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
566 {
567 /* Nothing to do. */
568 }
569
570
571 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
572 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
573 position of W. */
574
575 static void
576 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
577 {
578 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
579 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
580
581 updated_window = w;
582 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
583
584 BLOCK_INPUT;
585
586 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
587 {
588 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
589 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
590
591 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
592 highlighting. */
593 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
594 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
595 }
596
597 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
598 }
599
600
601 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
602
603 static void
604 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
605 {
606 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
607 struct face *face;
608
609 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
610 if (face)
611 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
612 face->foreground);
613
614 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
615 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
616 }
617
618 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
619
620 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
621 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
622
623 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
624 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
625 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
626
627 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
628 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
629 here. */
630
631 static void
632 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
633 {
634 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
635
636 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
637 {
638 BLOCK_INPUT;
639
640 if (cursor_on_p)
641 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
642 output_cursor.vpos,
643 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
644
645 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
646 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
647
648 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
649 }
650
651 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
652 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
653 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
654 {
655 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
656 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
657 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
658 }
659
660 updated_window = NULL;
661 }
662
663
664 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
665 update_end. */
666
667 static void
668 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
669 {
670 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
671 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
672
673 #ifndef XFlush
674 BLOCK_INPUT;
675 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
676 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
677 #endif
678 }
679
680
681 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
682 complete update has been performed. The global variable
683 updated_window is not available here. */
684
685 static void
686 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
687 {
688 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
689 {
690 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
691
692 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
693 || f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
694 {
695 BLOCK_INPUT;
696 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
697 note_mouse_highlight (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
698 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
699 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
700 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
701 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
702 }
703 }
704 }
705
706
707 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
708 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
709 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
710 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
711 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
712 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
713
714 static void
715 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
716 {
717 struct window *w = updated_window;
718 struct frame *f;
719 int width, height;
720
721 xassert (w);
722
723 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
724 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
725
726 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
727 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
728 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
729 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
730 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
731 overhead is very small. */
732 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
733 && desired_row->full_width_p
734 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
735 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
736 width != 0)
737 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
738 height > 0))
739 {
740 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
741
742 BLOCK_INPUT;
743 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
744 0, y, width, height, False);
745 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
746 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
747 y, width, height, False);
748 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
749 }
750 }
751
752 static void
753 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
754 {
755 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
756 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
757 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
758 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
759 struct face *face = p->face;
760
761 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
762 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
763
764 if (!p->overlay_p)
765 {
766 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
767
768 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
769 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
770 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
771 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
772 if (face->stipple)
773 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
774 else
775 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
776
777 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
778 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
779 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
780 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
781 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
782 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
783 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
784 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
785 {
786 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
787
788 if (sb_width > 0)
789 {
790 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
791 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
792 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
793
794 if (bx < 0)
795 {
796 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
797 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == p->x)
798 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
799 else if (p->x + p->wd == bar_area_x)
800 bx = bar_area_x;
801 if (bx >= 0)
802 {
803 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
804
805 nx = bar_area_width - sb_width;
806 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
807 row->y));
808 ny = row->visible_height;
809 }
810 }
811 else
812 {
813 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == bx)
814 {
815 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
816 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
817 }
818 else if (bx + nx == bar_area_x)
819 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
820 }
821 }
822 }
823 #endif
824 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
825 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
826
827 if (!face->stipple)
828 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
829 }
830
831 if (p->which)
832 {
833 char *bits;
834 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
835 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
836 XGCValues gcv;
837
838 if (p->wd > 8)
839 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
840 else
841 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
842
843 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
844 by the server. */
845 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
846 (p->cursor_p
847 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
848 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
849 : face->foreground),
850 face->background, depth);
851
852 if (p->overlay_p)
853 {
854 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
855 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
856 bits, p->wd, p->h,
857 1, 0, 1);
858 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
859 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
860 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
861 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
862 }
863
864 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
865 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
866 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
867
868 if (p->overlay_p)
869 {
870 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
871 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
872 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
873 }
874 }
875
876 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
877 }
878
879 \f
880
881 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
882 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
883 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
884 rarely happens). */
885
886 static void
887 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
888 {
889 }
890
891 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
892 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
893
894 static void
895 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
896 {
897 }
898
899 \f
900 /***********************************************************************
901 Glyph display
902 ***********************************************************************/
903
904
905
906 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
907 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
908 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
909 int);
910 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
911 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
912 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
913 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
914 static void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int) NO_RETURN;
915 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
916 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
917 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
918 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
919 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
920 unsigned long *, double, int);
921 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
922 double, int, unsigned long);
923 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
924 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
925 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
926 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
927 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
928 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
929 int, int, int);
930 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
931 int, int, int, int, int, int,
932 XRectangle *);
933 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
934 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
935 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
936
937 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
938 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
939 #endif
940
941
942 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
943 face. */
944
945 static void
946 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
947 {
948 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
949 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
950 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
951 && !s->cmp)
952 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
953 else
954 {
955 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
956 XGCValues xgcv;
957 unsigned long mask;
958
959 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
960 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
961
962 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
963 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
964 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
965 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
966 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
967 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
968 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
969
970 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
971 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
972 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
973 {
974 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
975 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
976 }
977
978 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
979 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
980 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
981
982 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
983 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
984 mask, &xgcv);
985 else
986 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
987 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
988
989 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
990 }
991 }
992
993
994 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
995
996 static void
997 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
998 {
999 int face_id;
1000 struct face *face;
1001
1002 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1003 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1004 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1005 if (face == NULL)
1006 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1007
1008 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1009 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
1010 else
1011 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
1012 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1013 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1014
1015 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1016 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1017 else
1018 {
1019 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1020 except for FONT. */
1021 XGCValues xgcv;
1022 unsigned long mask;
1023
1024 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1025 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1026 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1027 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
1028
1029 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1030 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1031 mask, &xgcv);
1032 else
1033 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1034 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1035
1036 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1037
1038 }
1039 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1040 }
1041
1042
1043 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1044 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1045 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1046
1047 static inline void
1048 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1049 {
1050 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1051 }
1052
1053
1054 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1055 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1056 pattern. */
1057
1058 static inline void
1059 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1060 {
1061 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1062
1063 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1064 {
1065 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1066 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1067 }
1068 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1069 {
1070 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1071 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1072 }
1073 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1074 {
1075 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1076 s->stippled_p = 0;
1077 }
1078 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1079 {
1080 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1081 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1082 }
1083 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1084 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1085 {
1086 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1087 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1088 }
1089 else
1090 {
1091 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1092 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1093 }
1094
1095 /* GC must have been set. */
1096 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1097 }
1098
1099
1100 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1101 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1102
1103 static inline void
1104 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1105 {
1106 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1107 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1108
1109 if (n > 0)
1110 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1111 s->num_clips = n;
1112 }
1113
1114
1115 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1116 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1117 the area of SRC. */
1118
1119 static void
1120 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1121 {
1122 XRectangle r;
1123
1124 r.x = src->x;
1125 r.width = src->width;
1126 r.y = src->y;
1127 r.height = src->height;
1128 dst->clip[0] = r;
1129 dst->num_clips = 1;
1130 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1131 }
1132
1133
1134 /* RIF:
1135 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1136
1137 static void
1138 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1139 {
1140 if (s->cmp == NULL
1141 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1142 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1143 {
1144 struct font_metrics metrics;
1145
1146 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1147 {
1148 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1149 struct font *font = s->font;
1150 int i;
1151
1152 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1153 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1154 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1155 }
1156 else
1157 {
1158 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1159
1160 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1161 }
1162 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1163 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1164 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1165 }
1166 else if (s->cmp)
1167 {
1168 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1169 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1170 }
1171 }
1172
1173
1174 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1175
1176 static inline void
1177 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1178 {
1179 XGCValues xgcv;
1180 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1181 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1182 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1183 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1184 }
1185
1186
1187 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1188 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1189 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1190 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1191 contains the first component of a composition. */
1192
1193 static void
1194 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1195 {
1196 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1197 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1198 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1199 {
1200 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1201
1202 if (s->stippled_p)
1203 {
1204 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1205 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1206 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1207 s->y + box_line_width,
1208 s->background_width,
1209 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1210 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1211 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1212 }
1213 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1214 || s->font_not_found_p
1215 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1216 || force_p)
1217 {
1218 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1219 s->background_width,
1220 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1221 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1222 }
1223 }
1224 }
1225
1226
1227 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1228
1229 static void
1230 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1231 {
1232 int i, x;
1233
1234 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1235 of S to the right of that box line. */
1236 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1237 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1238 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1239 else
1240 x = s->x;
1241
1242 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1243 loaded. */
1244 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1245 {
1246 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1247 {
1248 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1249 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1250 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1251 s->height - 1);
1252 x += g->pixel_width;
1253 }
1254 }
1255 else
1256 {
1257 struct font *font = s->font;
1258 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1259 int y;
1260
1261 if (font->vertical_centering)
1262 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1263
1264 y = s->ybase - boff;
1265 if (s->for_overlaps
1266 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1267 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1268 else
1269 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1270 if (s->face->overstrike)
1271 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1272 }
1273 }
1274
1275 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1276
1277 static void
1278 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1279 {
1280 int i, j, x;
1281 struct font *font = s->font;
1282
1283 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1284 of S to the right of that box line. */
1285 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1286 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1287 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1288 else
1289 x = s->x;
1290
1291 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1292 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1293 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1294 this composition. */
1295
1296 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1297 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1298 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1299 {
1300 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1301 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1302 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1303 }
1304 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1305 {
1306 int y = s->ybase;
1307
1308 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1309 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1310 space on the left or right. */
1311 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1312 {
1313 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1314 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1315
1316 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1317 if (s->face->overstrike)
1318 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1319 }
1320 }
1321 else
1322 {
1323 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1324 Lisp_Object glyph;
1325 int y = s->ybase;
1326 int width = 0;
1327
1328 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1329 {
1330 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1331 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1332 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1333 else
1334 {
1335 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1336
1337 if (j < i)
1338 {
1339 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1340 if (s->face->overstrike)
1341 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1342 x += width;
1343 }
1344 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1345 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1346 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1347 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1348 if (s->face->overstrike)
1349 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1350 x += wadjust;
1351 j = i + 1;
1352 width = 0;
1353 }
1354 }
1355 if (j < i)
1356 {
1357 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1358 if (s->face->overstrike)
1359 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1360 }
1361 }
1362 }
1363
1364
1365 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1366
1367 static void
1368 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1369 {
1370 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1371 XChar2b char2b[8];
1372 int x, i, j;
1373
1374 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1375 of S to the right of that box line. */
1376 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1377 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1378 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1379 else
1380 x = s->x;
1381
1382 s->char2b = char2b;
1383
1384 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1385 {
1386 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1387 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1388
1389 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1390 {
1391 if (len > 0
1392 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1393 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1394 >= 1))
1395 {
1396 Lisp_Object acronym
1397 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1398 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1399 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1400 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1401 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1402 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1403 }
1404 }
1405 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1406 {
1407 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1408 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1409 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1410 str = buf;
1411 }
1412
1413 if (str)
1414 {
1415 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1416 unsigned code;
1417
1418 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1419 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1420 {
1421 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1422 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1423 }
1424 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1425 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1426 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1427 0);
1428 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1429 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1430 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1431 0);
1432 }
1433 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1434 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1435 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1436 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1437 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1438 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1439 }
1440 }
1441
1442 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1443
1444 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget (Widget);
1445 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1446 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1447 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1448 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1449
1450
1451 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1452 cannot be determined. */
1453
1454 static struct frame *
1455 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1456 {
1457 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1458 Lisp_Object tail;
1459 struct frame *f;
1460
1461 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1462
1463 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1464 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1465 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1466 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1467 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1468 widget = XtParent (widget);
1469
1470 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1471 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1472 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1473 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1474 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1475 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1476 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1477 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1478 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1479 return f;
1480
1481 abort ();
1482 }
1483
1484
1485 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1486
1487 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1488 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1489 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1490 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1491 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1492 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1493
1494 int
1495 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1496 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1497 {
1498 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1499 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1500 }
1501
1502 #endif
1503
1504
1505 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1506 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1507
1508 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1509 {
1510 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1511 sizeof (Screen *)},
1512 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1513 sizeof (Colormap)}
1514 };
1515
1516
1517 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1518 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1519
1520 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1521
1522
1523 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1524
1525 DPY is the display we are working on.
1526
1527 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1528 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1529 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1530 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1531
1532 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1533 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1534
1535 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1536 we allocated the color or not.
1537
1538 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1539
1540 static Boolean
1541 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1542 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1543 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1544 {
1545 Screen *screen;
1546 Colormap cmap;
1547 Pixel pixel;
1548 String color_name;
1549 XColor color;
1550
1551 if (*nargs != 2)
1552 {
1553 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1554 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1555 "XtToolkitError",
1556 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1557 return False;
1558 }
1559
1560 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1561 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1562 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1563
1564 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1565 {
1566 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1567 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1568 }
1569 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1570 {
1571 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1572 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1573 }
1574 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1575 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1576 {
1577 pixel = color.pixel;
1578 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1579 }
1580 else
1581 {
1582 String params[1];
1583 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1584
1585 params[0] = color_name;
1586 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1587 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1588 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1589 params, &nparams);
1590 return False;
1591 }
1592
1593 if (to->addr != NULL)
1594 {
1595 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1596 {
1597 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1598 return False;
1599 }
1600
1601 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1602 }
1603 else
1604 {
1605 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1606 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1607 }
1608
1609 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1610 return True;
1611 }
1612
1613
1614 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1615 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1616 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1617
1618 APP is the application context in which we work.
1619
1620 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1621 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1622 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1623
1624 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1625
1626 static void
1627 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1628 Cardinal *nargs)
1629 {
1630 if (*nargs != 2)
1631 {
1632 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1633 "XtToolkitError",
1634 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1635 NULL, NULL);
1636 }
1637 else if (closure != NULL)
1638 {
1639 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1640 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1641 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1642 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1643 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1644 }
1645 }
1646
1647
1648 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1649
1650
1651 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1652 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1653 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1654 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1655
1656 static const XColor *
1657 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1658 {
1659 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1660
1661 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1662 {
1663 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1664 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1665 int i;
1666
1667 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1668 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1669 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1670
1671 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1672 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1673
1674 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1675 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1676 }
1677
1678 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1679 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1680 }
1681
1682
1683 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1684 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1685
1686 void
1687 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1688 {
1689 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1690
1691 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1692 {
1693 int i;
1694 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1695 {
1696 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1697 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1698 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1699 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1700 }
1701 }
1702 else
1703 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1704 }
1705
1706
1707 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1708 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1709
1710 void
1711 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1712 {
1713 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1714 }
1715
1716
1717 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1718 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1719 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1720 allocated. */
1721
1722 static int
1723 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1724 {
1725 int rc;
1726
1727 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1728 if (rc == 0)
1729 {
1730 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1731 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1732 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1733 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1734 int nearest, i;
1735 int max_color_delta = 255;
1736 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1737 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1738 int ncells;
1739 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1740
1741 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1742 {
1743 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1744 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1745 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1746 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1747
1748 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1749 {
1750 nearest = i;
1751 nearest_delta = delta;
1752 }
1753 }
1754
1755 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1756 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1757 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1758 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1759 }
1760 else
1761 {
1762 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1763 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1764 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1765 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1766 XColor *cached_color;
1767
1768 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1769 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1770 (cached_color->red != color->red
1771 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1772 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1773 {
1774 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1775 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1776 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1777 }
1778 }
1779
1780 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1781 if (rc)
1782 register_color (color->pixel);
1783 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1784
1785 return rc;
1786 }
1787
1788
1789 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1790 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1791 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1792 allocated. */
1793
1794 int
1795 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1796 {
1797 gamma_correct (f, color);
1798 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1799 }
1800
1801
1802 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1803 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1804 get color reference counts right. */
1805
1806 unsigned long
1807 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1808 {
1809 XColor color;
1810
1811 color.pixel = pixel;
1812 BLOCK_INPUT;
1813 x_query_color (f, &color);
1814 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1815 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1816 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1817 register_color (pixel);
1818 #endif
1819 return color.pixel;
1820 }
1821
1822
1823 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1824 boosted.
1825
1826 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1827 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1828 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1829 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1830 use an additional additive factor.
1831
1832 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1833 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1834 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1835
1836
1837 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1838 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1839 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1840 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1841 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1842 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1843
1844 static int
1845 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1846 {
1847 XColor color, new;
1848 long bright;
1849 int success_p;
1850
1851 /* Get RGB color values. */
1852 color.pixel = *pixel;
1853 x_query_color (f, &color);
1854
1855 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1856 xassert (factor >= 0);
1857 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1858 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1859 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1860
1861 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1862 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1863
1864 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1865 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1866 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1867 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1868 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1869 {
1870 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1871 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1872 /* The additive adjustment. */
1873 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1874
1875 if (factor < 1)
1876 {
1877 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1878 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1879 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1880 }
1881 else
1882 {
1883 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1884 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1885 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1886 }
1887 }
1888
1889 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1890 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1891 if (success_p)
1892 {
1893 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1894 {
1895 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1896 delta to the RGB values. */
1897 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1898
1899 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1900 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1901 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1902 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1903 }
1904 else
1905 success_p = 1;
1906 *pixel = new.pixel;
1907 }
1908
1909 return success_p;
1910 }
1911
1912
1913 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1914 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1915 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1916 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1917 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1918 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1919
1920 static void
1921 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1922 {
1923 XGCValues xgcv;
1924 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1925 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1926 unsigned long pixel;
1927 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1928 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1929 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1930 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1931
1932 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1933 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1934
1935 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1936 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1937 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1938 if (relief->gc
1939 && relief->allocated_p)
1940 {
1941 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1942 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1943 }
1944
1945 /* Allocate new color. */
1946 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1947 pixel = background;
1948 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1949 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1950 {
1951 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1952 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1953 }
1954
1955 if (relief->gc == 0)
1956 {
1957 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1958 mask |= GCStipple;
1959 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1960 }
1961 else
1962 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1963 }
1964
1965
1966 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1967
1968 static void
1969 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1970 {
1971 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1972 unsigned long color;
1973
1974 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1975 color = s->face->box_color;
1976 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1977 && s->img->pixmap
1978 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1979 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1980 else
1981 {
1982 XGCValues xgcv;
1983
1984 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1985 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1986 color = xgcv.background;
1987 }
1988
1989 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1990 || color != di->relief_background)
1991 {
1992 di->relief_background = color;
1993 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1994 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1995 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1996 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1997 }
1998 }
1999
2000
2001 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2002 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2003 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2004 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2005 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2006 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2007 when drawing. */
2008
2009 static void
2010 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
2011 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2012 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
2013 XRectangle *clip_rect)
2014 {
2015 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2016 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2017 int i;
2018 GC gc;
2019
2020 if (raised_p)
2021 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2022 else
2023 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2024 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2025
2026 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
2027 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
2028 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
2029 corner pixels. */
2030
2031 /* Top. */
2032 if (top_p)
2033 {
2034 if (width == 1)
2035 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2036 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2037 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2038
2039 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2040 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2041 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2042 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2043 }
2044
2045 /* Left. */
2046 if (left_p)
2047 {
2048 if (width == 1)
2049 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2050
2051 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2052 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2053
2054 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2055 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2056 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2057 }
2058
2059 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2060 if (raised_p)
2061 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2062 else
2063 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2064 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2065
2066 if (width > 1)
2067 {
2068 /* Outermost top line. */
2069 if (top_p)
2070 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2071 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2072 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2073
2074 /* Outermost left line. */
2075 if (left_p)
2076 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2077 }
2078
2079 /* Bottom. */
2080 if (bot_p)
2081 {
2082 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2083 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2084 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2085 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2086 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2087 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2088 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2089 }
2090
2091 /* Right. */
2092 if (right_p)
2093 {
2094 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2095 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2096 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2097 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2098 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2099 }
2100
2101 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2102 }
2103
2104
2105 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2106 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2107 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2108 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2109 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2110 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2111
2112 static void
2113 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2114 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2115 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2116 {
2117 XGCValues xgcv;
2118
2119 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2120 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2121 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2122
2123 /* Top. */
2124 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2125 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2126
2127 /* Left. */
2128 if (left_p)
2129 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2130 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2131
2132 /* Bottom. */
2133 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2134 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2135
2136 /* Right. */
2137 if (right_p)
2138 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2139 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2140
2141 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2142 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2143 }
2144
2145
2146 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2147
2148 static void
2149 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2150 {
2151 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2152 int left_p, right_p;
2153 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2154 XRectangle clip_rect;
2155
2156 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2157 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2158 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2159
2160 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2161 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2162 ? s->first_glyph
2163 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2164
2165 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2166 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2167 left_x = s->x;
2168 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2169 ? last_x - 1
2170 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2171 top_y = s->y;
2172 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2173
2174 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2175 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2176 && (s->prev == NULL
2177 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2178 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2179 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2180 && (s->next == NULL
2181 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2182
2183 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2184
2185 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2186 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2187 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2188 else
2189 {
2190 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2191 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2192 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2193 }
2194 }
2195
2196
2197 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2198
2199 static void
2200 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2201 {
2202 int x = s->x;
2203 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2204
2205 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2206 right of that line. */
2207 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2208 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2209 && s->slice.x == 0)
2210 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2211
2212 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2213 by that margin. */
2214 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2215 x += s->img->hmargin;
2216 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2217 y += s->img->vmargin;
2218
2219 if (s->img->pixmap)
2220 {
2221 if (s->img->mask)
2222 {
2223 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2224 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2225 trust on the shape extension to be available
2226 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2227 manually. */
2228 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2229 | GCFunction);
2230 XGCValues xgcv;
2231 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2232
2233 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2234 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2235 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2236 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2237 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2238
2239 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2240 image_rect.x = x;
2241 image_rect.y = y;
2242 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2243 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2244 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2245 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2246 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2247 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2248 }
2249 else
2250 {
2251 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2252
2253 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2254 image_rect.x = x;
2255 image_rect.y = y;
2256 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2257 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2258 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2259 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2260 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2261 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2262
2263 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2264 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2265 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2266 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2267 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2268 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2269 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2270 {
2271 int relief = s->img->relief;
2272 if (relief < 0) relief = -relief;
2273 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2274 x - relief, y - relief,
2275 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2276 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2277 }
2278 }
2279 }
2280 else
2281 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2282 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2283 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2284 }
2285
2286
2287 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2288
2289 static void
2290 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2291 {
2292 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, extra;
2293 XRectangle r;
2294 int x = s->x;
2295 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2296
2297 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2298 right of that line. */
2299 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2300 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2301 && s->slice.x == 0)
2302 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2303
2304 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2305 by that margin. */
2306 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2307 x += s->img->hmargin;
2308 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2309 y += s->img->vmargin;
2310
2311 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2312 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2313 {
2314 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2315 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2316 }
2317 else
2318 {
2319 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2320 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2321 }
2322
2323 extra = s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
2324 ? XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin) : 0;
2325
2326 x0 = x - thick - extra;
2327 y0 = y - thick - extra;
2328 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra;
2329 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra;
2330
2331 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2332 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2333 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2334 s->slice.y == 0,
2335 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2336 s->slice.x == 0,
2337 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2338 &r);
2339 }
2340
2341
2342 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2343
2344 static void
2345 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2346 {
2347 int x = 0;
2348 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2349
2350 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2351 right of that line. */
2352 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2353 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2354 && s->slice.x == 0)
2355 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2356
2357 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2358 by that margin. */
2359 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2360 x += s->img->hmargin;
2361 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2362 y += s->img->vmargin;
2363
2364 if (s->img->pixmap)
2365 {
2366 if (s->img->mask)
2367 {
2368 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2369 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2370 trust on the shape extension to be available
2371 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2372 manually. */
2373 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2374 | GCFunction);
2375 XGCValues xgcv;
2376
2377 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2378 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2379 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2380 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2381 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2382
2383 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2384 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2385 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2386 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2387 }
2388 else
2389 {
2390 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2391 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2392 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2393
2394 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2395 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2396 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2397 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2398 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2399 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2400 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2401 {
2402 int r = s->img->relief;
2403 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2404 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2405 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2406 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2407 }
2408 }
2409 }
2410 else
2411 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2412 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2413 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2414 }
2415
2416
2417 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2418 give the rectangle to draw. */
2419
2420 static void
2421 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2422 {
2423 if (s->stippled_p)
2424 {
2425 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2426 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2427 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2428 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2429 }
2430 else
2431 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2432 }
2433
2434
2435 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2436
2437 s->y
2438 s->x +-------------------------
2439 | s->face->box
2440 |
2441 | +-------------------------
2442 | | s->img->margin
2443 | |
2444 | | +-------------------
2445 | | | the image
2446
2447 */
2448
2449 static void
2450 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2451 {
2452 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2453 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2454 int height;
2455 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2456
2457 height = s->height;
2458 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2459 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2460 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2461 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2462
2463 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2464 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2465 flickering. */
2466 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2467 if (height > s->slice.height
2468 || s->img->hmargin
2469 || s->img->vmargin
2470 || s->img->mask
2471 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2472 || s->width != s->background_width)
2473 {
2474 if (s->img->mask)
2475 {
2476 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2477 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2478 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2479 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2480 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2481
2482 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2483 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2484 s->background_width,
2485 s->height, depth);
2486
2487 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2488 pixmap. */
2489 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2490
2491 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2492 if (s->stippled_p)
2493 {
2494 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2495 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2496 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2497 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2498 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2499 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2500 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2501 }
2502 else
2503 {
2504 XGCValues xgcv;
2505 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2506 &xgcv);
2507 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2508 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2509 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2510 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2511 }
2512 }
2513 else
2514 {
2515 int x = s->x;
2516 int y = s->y;
2517
2518 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2519 && s->slice.x == 0)
2520 x += box_line_hwidth;
2521
2522 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2523 y += box_line_vwidth;
2524
2525 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2526 }
2527
2528 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2529 }
2530
2531 /* Draw the foreground. */
2532 if (pixmap != None)
2533 {
2534 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2535 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2536 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2537 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2538 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2539 }
2540 else
2541 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2542
2543 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2544 if (s->img->relief
2545 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2546 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2547 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2548 }
2549
2550
2551 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2552
2553 static void
2554 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2555 {
2556 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2557
2558 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2559 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2560 {
2561 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2562 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2563 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2564 int x = s->x;
2565
2566 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2567 {
2568 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2569
2570 if (x < left_x)
2571 {
2572 background_width -= left_x - x;
2573 x = left_x;
2574 }
2575 }
2576 else
2577 {
2578 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2579 stretch glyph. */
2580 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2581
2582 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2583 background_width -= x - right_x;
2584 x += background_width;
2585 }
2586 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2587 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2588 x -= width;
2589
2590 /* Draw cursor. */
2591 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2592
2593 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2594 if (width < background_width)
2595 {
2596 int y = s->y;
2597 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2598 XRectangle r;
2599 GC gc;
2600
2601 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2602 x += width;
2603 else
2604 x = s->x;
2605 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2606 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2607 {
2608 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2609 gc = s->gc;
2610 }
2611 else
2612 gc = s->face->gc;
2613
2614 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2615 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2616
2617 if (s->face->stipple)
2618 {
2619 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2620 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2621 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2622 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2623 }
2624 else
2625 {
2626 XGCValues xgcv;
2627 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2628 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2629 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2630 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2631 }
2632 }
2633 }
2634 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2635 {
2636 int background_width = s->background_width;
2637 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2638
2639 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2640 except for header line and mode line. */
2641 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2642 {
2643 background_width -= left_x - x;
2644 x = left_x;
2645 }
2646 if (background_width > 0)
2647 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2648 }
2649
2650 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2651 }
2652
2653
2654 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2655
2656 static void
2657 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2658 {
2659 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2660
2661 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2662 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2663 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2664 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2665 {
2666 int width;
2667 struct glyph_string *next;
2668
2669 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2670 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2671 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2672 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2673 {
2674 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2675 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2676 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2677 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2678 else
2679 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2680 next->num_clips = 0;
2681 }
2682 }
2683
2684 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2685 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2686
2687 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2688 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2689 if (!s->for_overlaps
2690 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2691 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2692 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2693
2694 {
2695 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2696 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2697 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2698 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2699 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2700 }
2701 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2702 && !s->clip_tail
2703 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2704 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2705 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2706 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2707 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2708 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2709 else
2710 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2711
2712 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2713 {
2714 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2715 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2716 break;
2717
2718 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2719 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2720 break;
2721
2722 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2723 if (s->for_overlaps)
2724 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2725 else
2726 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2727 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2728 break;
2729
2730 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2731 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2732 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2733 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2734 else
2735 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2736 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2737 break;
2738
2739 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2740 if (s->for_overlaps)
2741 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2742 else
2743 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2744 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2745 break;
2746
2747 default:
2748 abort ();
2749 }
2750
2751 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2752 {
2753 /* Draw underline. */
2754 if (s->face->underline_p)
2755 {
2756 unsigned long thickness, position;
2757 int y;
2758
2759 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2760 {
2761 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2762 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2763 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2764 }
2765 else
2766 {
2767 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2768 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2769 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2770 else
2771 thickness = 1;
2772 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2773 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2774 else
2775 {
2776 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2777 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2778 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2779 specs, and its default is
2780
2781 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2782 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2783
2784 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2785 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2786 position = s->font->underline_position;
2787 else if (s->font)
2788 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2789 else
2790 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2791 }
2792 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2793 }
2794 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2795 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2796 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2797 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2798 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2799 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2800 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2801 s->underline_position = position;
2802 y = s->ybase + position;
2803 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2804 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2805 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2806 else
2807 {
2808 XGCValues xgcv;
2809 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2810 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2811 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2812 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2813 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2814 }
2815 }
2816
2817 /* Draw overline. */
2818 if (s->face->overline_p)
2819 {
2820 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2821
2822 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2823 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2824 s->width, h);
2825 else
2826 {
2827 XGCValues xgcv;
2828 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2829 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2830 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2831 s->width, h);
2832 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2833 }
2834 }
2835
2836 /* Draw strike-through. */
2837 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2838 {
2839 unsigned long h = 1;
2840 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2841
2842 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2843 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2844 s->width, h);
2845 else
2846 {
2847 XGCValues xgcv;
2848 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2849 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2850 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2851 s->width, h);
2852 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2853 }
2854 }
2855
2856 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2857 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2858 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2859
2860 if (s->prev)
2861 {
2862 struct glyph_string *prev;
2863
2864 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2865 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2866 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2867 {
2868 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2869 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2870 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2871
2872 prev->hl = s->hl;
2873 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2874 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2875 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2876 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2877 else
2878 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2879 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2880 prev->hl = save;
2881 prev->num_clips = 0;
2882 }
2883 }
2884
2885 if (s->next)
2886 {
2887 struct glyph_string *next;
2888
2889 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2890 if (next->hl != s->hl
2891 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2892 {
2893 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2894 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2895 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2896
2897 next->hl = s->hl;
2898 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2899 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2900 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2901 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2902 else
2903 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2904 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2905 next->hl = save;
2906 next->num_clips = 0;
2907 }
2908 }
2909 }
2910
2911 /* Reset clipping. */
2912 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2913 s->num_clips = 0;
2914 }
2915
2916 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2917
2918 static void
2919 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2920 {
2921 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2922 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2923 x, y, width, height,
2924 x + shift_by, y);
2925 }
2926
2927 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2928 for X frames. */
2929
2930 static void
2931 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2932 {
2933 abort ();
2934 }
2935
2936
2937 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2938 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2939
2940 void
2941 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2942 {
2943 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2944 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2945 }
2946
2947
2948 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2949
2950 static void
2951 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2952 {
2953 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2954 longer visible. */
2955 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2956 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2957 output_cursor.x = -1;
2958
2959 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2960 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2961 BLOCK_INPUT;
2962
2963 /* The following call is commented out because it does not seem to accomplish
2964 anything, apart from causing flickering during window resize. */
2965 /* XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f)); */
2966
2967 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
2968 something like that, then they should be notified. */
2969 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2970
2971 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
2972 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
2973 redisplay, do it here. */
2974 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
2975 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
2976 #endif
2977
2978 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2979
2980 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2981 }
2982
2983
2984 \f
2985 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2986
2987 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2988 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2989
2990 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2991
2992
2993 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2994 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2995
2996 static int
2997 timeval_subtract (struct timeval *result, struct timeval x, struct timeval y)
2998 {
2999 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
3000 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
3001 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
3002 {
3003 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
3004 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
3005 y.tv_sec += nsec;
3006 }
3007
3008 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
3009 {
3010 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
3011 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
3012 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
3013 }
3014
3015 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
3016 positive. */
3017 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
3018 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
3019
3020 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
3021 negative. */
3022 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
3023 }
3024
3025 static void
3026 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3027 {
3028 BLOCK_INPUT;
3029
3030 {
3031 #ifdef USE_GTK
3032 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3033 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3034 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3035 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3036 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3037 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3038 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3039 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3040 do { \
3041 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3042 cairo_fill (cr); \
3043 } \
3044 while (0)
3045 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3046 GdkGCValues vals;
3047 GdkGC *gc;
3048 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3049 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3050 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3051 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3052 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3053 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3054 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3055 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3056 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3057 GC gc;
3058
3059 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3060 pixels into background pixels. */
3061 {
3062 XGCValues values;
3063
3064 values.function = GXxor;
3065 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3066 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3067
3068 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3069 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3070 }
3071 #endif
3072 {
3073 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3074 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3075 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3076 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3077 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3078 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3079 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3080
3081 int width;
3082
3083 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3084 edge it is next to. */
3085 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3086 {
3087 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3088 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3089 break;
3090
3091 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3092 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3093 break;
3094
3095 default:
3096 break;
3097 }
3098
3099 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3100
3101 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3102 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3103 {
3104 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3105 flash_left,
3106 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3107 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3108 width, flash_height);
3109 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3110 flash_left,
3111 (height - flash_height
3112 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3113 width, flash_height);
3114
3115 }
3116 else
3117 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3118 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3119 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3120 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3121
3122 x_flush (f);
3123
3124 {
3125 struct timeval wakeup;
3126
3127 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
3128
3129 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
3130 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
3131 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
3132 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
3133
3134 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3135 available. */
3136 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3137 {
3138 struct timeval current;
3139 struct timeval timeout;
3140
3141 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
3142
3143 /* Break if result would be negative. */
3144 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
3145 break;
3146
3147 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3148 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
3149 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
3150
3151 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3152 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
3153 }
3154 }
3155
3156 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3157 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3158 {
3159 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3160 flash_left,
3161 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3162 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3163 width, flash_height);
3164 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3165 flash_left,
3166 (height - flash_height
3167 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3168 width, flash_height);
3169 }
3170 else
3171 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3172 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3173 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3174 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3175
3176 #ifdef USE_GTK
3177 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3178 cairo_destroy (cr);
3179 #else
3180 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3181 #endif
3182 #undef XFillRectangle
3183 #else
3184 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3185 #endif
3186 x_flush (f);
3187 }
3188 }
3189
3190 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3191 }
3192
3193 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3194
3195
3196 static void
3197 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3198 {
3199 BLOCK_INPUT;
3200 if (invisible)
3201 {
3202 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3203 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3204 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3205 }
3206 else
3207 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3208 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3209 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3210 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3211 }
3212
3213
3214 /* Make audible bell. */
3215
3216 static void
3217 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3218 {
3219 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3220 {
3221 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3222 if (visible_bell)
3223 XTflash (f);
3224 else
3225 #endif
3226 {
3227 BLOCK_INPUT;
3228 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3229 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3230 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3231 }
3232 }
3233 }
3234
3235 \f
3236 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3237 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3238 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3239 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3240
3241 static void
3242 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3243 {
3244 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3245 }
3246
3247
3248 \f
3249 /***********************************************************************
3250 Line Dance
3251 ***********************************************************************/
3252
3253 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3254 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3255
3256 static void
3257 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3258 {
3259 abort ();
3260 }
3261
3262
3263 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3264
3265 static void
3266 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3267 {
3268 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3269 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3270
3271 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3272 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3273 fringe of W. */
3274 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3275
3276 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3277 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3278 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3279 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3280 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
3281 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
3282 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
3283 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
3284 {
3285 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
3286
3287 if (sb_width > 0)
3288 {
3289 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
3290 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
3291 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
3292
3293 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == x)
3294 {
3295 x = bar_area_x + sb_width;
3296 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3297 }
3298 else if (x + width == bar_area_x)
3299 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3300 }
3301 }
3302 #endif
3303
3304 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3305 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3306 bottom_y = y + height;
3307
3308 if (to_y < from_y)
3309 {
3310 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3311 line at the bottom. */
3312 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3313 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3314 else
3315 height = run->height;
3316 }
3317 else
3318 {
3319 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3320 at the bottom. */
3321 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3322 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3323 else
3324 height = run->height;
3325 }
3326
3327 BLOCK_INPUT;
3328
3329 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3330 updated_window = w;
3331 x_clear_cursor (w);
3332
3333 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3334 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3335 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3336 x, from_y,
3337 width, height,
3338 x, to_y);
3339
3340 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3341 }
3342
3343
3344 \f
3345 /***********************************************************************
3346 Exposure Events
3347 ***********************************************************************/
3348
3349 \f
3350 static void
3351 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3352 {
3353 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3354 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3355 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3356 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3357 BLOCK_INPUT;
3358 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3359 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3360 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3361 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3362 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3363 }
3364
3365 static void
3366 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3367 {
3368 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3369 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3370 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3371 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3372 BLOCK_INPUT;
3373 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3374 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3375 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3376 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3377 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3378 }
3379
3380 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3381 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3382 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3383 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3384 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3385
3386 static void
3387 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3388 {
3389 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3390
3391 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3392 {
3393 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3394 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3395 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3396
3397 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3398 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3399
3400 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3401 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3402 else
3403 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3404 }
3405
3406 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3407 }
3408
3409 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3410 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3411 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3412
3413 static void
3414 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3415 {
3416 if (type == FocusIn)
3417 {
3418 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3419 {
3420 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3421 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3422
3423 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3424 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3425 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3426 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3427 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3428 {
3429 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3430 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3431 }
3432 }
3433
3434 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3435
3436 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3437 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3438 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3439 #endif
3440 }
3441 else if (type == FocusOut)
3442 {
3443 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3444
3445 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3446 {
3447 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3448 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3449 }
3450
3451 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3452 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3453 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3454 #endif
3455 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3456 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3457 }
3458 }
3459
3460 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3461 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3462
3463 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3464
3465 static void
3466 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3467 {
3468 struct frame *frame;
3469
3470 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3471 if (! frame)
3472 return;
3473
3474 switch (event->type)
3475 {
3476 case EnterNotify:
3477 case LeaveNotify:
3478 {
3479 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3480 int focus_state
3481 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3482
3483 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3484 && event->xcrossing.focus
3485 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3486 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3487 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3488 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3489 }
3490 break;
3491
3492 case FocusIn:
3493 case FocusOut:
3494 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3495 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3496 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3497 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3498 break;
3499
3500 case ClientMessage:
3501 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3502 {
3503 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3504 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3505 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3506 }
3507 break;
3508 }
3509 }
3510
3511
3512 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3513 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3514
3515 void
3516 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3517 {
3518 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3519 }
3520 #endif
3521
3522 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3523 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3524 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3525
3526 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3527 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3528 the appropriate X display info. */
3529
3530 static void
3531 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3532 {
3533 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3534 }
3535
3536 static void
3537 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3538 {
3539 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3540
3541 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3542 {
3543 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3544 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3545 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3546 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3547 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3548 {
3549 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3550 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3551 }
3552 }
3553 else
3554 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3555
3556 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3557 {
3558 if (old_highlight)
3559 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3560 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3561 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3562 }
3563 }
3564
3565
3566 \f
3567 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3568
3569 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3570 static void
3571 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3572 {
3573 int min_code, max_code;
3574 KeySym *syms;
3575 int syms_per_code;
3576 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3577
3578 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3579 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3580 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3581 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3582 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3583
3584 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3585
3586 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3587 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3588 &syms_per_code);
3589 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3590
3591 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3592 Alt keysyms are on. */
3593 {
3594 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3595 int found_alt_or_meta;
3596
3597 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3598 {
3599 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3600 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3601 {
3602 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3603
3604 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3605 if (code == 0)
3606 continue;
3607
3608 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3609 {
3610 int code_col;
3611
3612 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3613 {
3614 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3615
3616 switch (sym)
3617 {
3618 case XK_Meta_L:
3619 case XK_Meta_R:
3620 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3621 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3622 break;
3623
3624 case XK_Alt_L:
3625 case XK_Alt_R:
3626 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3627 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3628 break;
3629
3630 case XK_Hyper_L:
3631 case XK_Hyper_R:
3632 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3633 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3634 code_col = syms_per_code;
3635 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3636 break;
3637
3638 case XK_Super_L:
3639 case XK_Super_R:
3640 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3641 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3642 code_col = syms_per_code;
3643 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3644 break;
3645
3646 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3647 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3648 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3649 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3650 code_col = syms_per_code;
3651 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3652 break;
3653 }
3654 }
3655 }
3656 }
3657 }
3658 }
3659
3660 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3661 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3662 {
3663 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3664 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3665 }
3666
3667 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3668 make them just meta, not alt. */
3669 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3670 {
3671 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3672 }
3673
3674 XFree ((char *) syms);
3675 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3676 }
3677
3678 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3679 Emacs uses. */
3680
3681 int
3682 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3683 {
3684 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3685 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3686 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3687 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3688 Lisp_Object tem;
3689
3690 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3691 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3692 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3693 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3694 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3695 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3696 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3697 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3698
3699 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3700 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3701 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3702 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3703 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3704 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3705 }
3706
3707 static int
3708 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3709 {
3710 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3711 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3712 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3713 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3714
3715 Lisp_Object tem;
3716
3717 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3718 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3719 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3720 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3721 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3722 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3723 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3724 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3725
3726
3727 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3728 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3729 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3730 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3731 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3732 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3733 }
3734
3735 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3736
3737 char *
3738 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3739 {
3740 char *value;
3741
3742 BLOCK_INPUT;
3743 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3744 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3745
3746 return value;
3747 }
3748
3749
3750 \f
3751 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3752
3753 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3754
3755 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3756 the mouse. */
3757
3758 static Lisp_Object
3759 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3760 {
3761 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3762 otherwise. */
3763 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3764 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3765 result->timestamp = event->time;
3766 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3767 event->state)
3768 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3769 ? up_modifier
3770 : down_modifier));
3771
3772 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3773 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3774 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3775 result->arg = Qnil;
3776 return Qnil;
3777 }
3778
3779 \f
3780 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3781 The input handler calls this.
3782
3783 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3784 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3785 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3786 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3787
3788 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3789 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3790
3791 static int
3792 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3793 {
3794 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3795 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3796 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3797
3798 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3799 return 0;
3800
3801 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3802 {
3803 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3804 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3805 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3806 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3807 return 1;
3808 }
3809
3810
3811 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3812 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3813 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3814 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3815 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3816 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3817 {
3818 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3819 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3820 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3821 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3822 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3823 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3824 return 1;
3825 }
3826
3827 return 0;
3828 }
3829
3830 \f
3831 /************************************************************************
3832 Mouse Face
3833 ************************************************************************/
3834
3835 static void
3836 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3837 {
3838 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3839 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3840 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3841 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3842 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3843 }
3844
3845
3846
3847 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3848 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3849
3850 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3851 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3852 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3853 position on the scroll bar.
3854
3855 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3856 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3857 the mouse is over.
3858
3859 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3860 was at this position.
3861
3862 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3863
3864 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3865 movement. */
3866
3867 static void
3868 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3869 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3870 Time *timestamp)
3871 {
3872 FRAME_PTR f1;
3873
3874 BLOCK_INPUT;
3875
3876 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3877 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3878 else
3879 {
3880 Window root;
3881 int root_x, root_y;
3882
3883 Window dummy_window;
3884 int dummy;
3885
3886 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3887
3888 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3889 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3890 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3891 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3892 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3893
3894 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3895
3896 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3897 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3898 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3899
3900 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3901 &root,
3902
3903 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3904 a different screen. */
3905 &dummy_window,
3906
3907 /* The position on that root window. */
3908 &root_x, &root_y,
3909
3910 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3911 &dummy, &dummy,
3912
3913 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3914 we don't care. */
3915 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3916
3917 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3918 containing the pointer. */
3919 {
3920 Window win, child;
3921 int win_x, win_y;
3922 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3923
3924 win = root;
3925
3926 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3927 structure is changing at the same time this function
3928 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3929
3930 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3931
3932 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3933 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3934 {
3935 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3936 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3937 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3938
3939 /* From-window, to-window. */
3940 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3941
3942 /* From-position, to-position. */
3943 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3944
3945 /* Child of win. */
3946 &child);
3947 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3948 }
3949 else
3950 {
3951 while (1)
3952 {
3953 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3954
3955 /* From-window, to-window. */
3956 root, win,
3957
3958 /* From-position, to-position. */
3959 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3960
3961 /* Child of win. */
3962 &child);
3963
3964 if (child == None || child == win)
3965 break;
3966 #ifdef USE_GTK
3967 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3968 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3969 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3970 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3971 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3972 break;
3973 #endif
3974 win = child;
3975 parent_x = win_x;
3976 parent_y = win_y;
3977 }
3978
3979 /* Now we know that:
3980 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3981 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3982 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3983 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3984 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3985 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3986 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3987 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3988 never use them in that case.) */
3989
3990 #ifdef USE_GTK
3991 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3992 want the edit window. */
3993 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3994 #else
3995 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3996 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3997 #endif
3998
3999 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4000 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4001 on the frame. */
4002 if (f1 != NULL
4003 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4004 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4005 f1 = NULL;
4006 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4007 }
4008
4009 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4010 f1 = 0;
4011
4012 x_uncatch_errors ();
4013
4014 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4015 if (! f1)
4016 {
4017 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4018
4019 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4020
4021 if (bar)
4022 {
4023 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4024 win_x = parent_x;
4025 win_y = parent_y;
4026 }
4027 }
4028
4029 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4030 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4031
4032 if (f1)
4033 {
4034 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4035 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4036 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4037 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4038 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4039 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4040 the frame are divided into. */
4041
4042 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4043 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4044
4045 *bar_window = Qnil;
4046 *part = 0;
4047 *fp = f1;
4048 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4049 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4050 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
4051 }
4052 }
4053 }
4054
4055 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4056 }
4057
4058
4059 \f
4060 /***********************************************************************
4061 Scroll bars
4062 ***********************************************************************/
4063
4064 /* Scroll bar support. */
4065
4066 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4067 manages it.
4068 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4069 bits. */
4070
4071 static struct scroll_bar *
4072 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4073 {
4074 Lisp_Object tail;
4075
4076 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4077 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4078 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4079
4080 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4081 {
4082 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
4083
4084 frame = XCAR (tail);
4085 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4086 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
4087 abort ();
4088
4089 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4090 continue;
4091
4092 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4093 right window ID. */
4094 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4095 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4096 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4097 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4098 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4099 condemned = Qnil,
4100 ! NILP (bar));
4101 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4102 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4103 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4104 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4105 }
4106
4107 return NULL;
4108 }
4109
4110
4111 #if defined USE_LUCID
4112
4113 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4114 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4115
4116 static Widget
4117 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4118 {
4119 Lisp_Object tail;
4120
4121 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4122 {
4123 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4124 {
4125 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4126 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4127
4128 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4129 return menu_bar;
4130 }
4131 }
4132
4133 return NULL;
4134 }
4135
4136 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4137
4138 \f
4139 /************************************************************************
4140 Toolkit scroll bars
4141 ************************************************************************/
4142
4143 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4144
4145 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4146 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4147 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4148 struct scroll_bar *);
4149 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4150 int, int, int);
4151
4152
4153 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4154 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4155
4156 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4157
4158 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4159
4160 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4161
4162 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4163 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4164
4165 #ifndef USE_GTK
4166 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4167
4168 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4169
4170 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4171
4172 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4173 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4174 to avoid jerkyness. */
4175
4176 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4177
4178 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4179 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4180 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4181 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4182
4183 static void
4184 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4185 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4186 {
4187 int scroll_bar_p;
4188 const char *end_action;
4189
4190 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4191 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4192 end_action = "Release";
4193 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4194 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4195 end_action = "EndScroll";
4196 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4197
4198 if (scroll_bar_p
4199 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4200 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4201 {
4202 struct window *w;
4203
4204 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4205 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4206 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4207
4208 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4209 {
4210 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4211 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4212 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4213 }
4214 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4215 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4216
4217 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4218 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4219 }
4220 }
4221 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4222
4223 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4224 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4225
4226 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4227 static ptrdiff_t scroll_bar_windows_size;
4228
4229
4230 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4231 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4232 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4233 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4234
4235 static void
4236 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4237 {
4238 XEvent event;
4239 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4240 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4241 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4242 ptrdiff_t i;
4243
4244 BLOCK_INPUT;
4245
4246 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4247 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4248 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4249 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4250 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4251 ev->format = 32;
4252
4253 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4254 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4255 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4256 into that array in the event. */
4257 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4258 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4259 break;
4260
4261 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4262 {
4263 ptrdiff_t old_nbytes =
4264 scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4265 ptrdiff_t nbytes;
4266 enum { XClientMessageEvent_MAX = 0x7fffffff };
4267 scroll_bar_windows =
4268 xpalloc (scroll_bar_windows, &scroll_bar_windows_size, 1,
4269 XClientMessageEvent_MAX, sizeof *scroll_bar_windows);
4270 nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4271 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4272 }
4273
4274 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4275 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4276 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4277 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4278 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4279 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4280
4281 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4282 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4283 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4284 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4285 #endif
4286
4287 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4288 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4289 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4290 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4291 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4292 }
4293
4294
4295 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4296 in *IEVENT. */
4297
4298 static void
4299 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4300 {
4301 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4302 Lisp_Object window;
4303 struct window *w;
4304
4305 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4306 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4307
4308 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4309
4310 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4311 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4312 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4313 #ifdef USE_GTK
4314 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4315 #else
4316 ievent->timestamp =
4317 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4318 #endif
4319 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4320 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4321 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4322 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4323 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4324 }
4325
4326
4327 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4328
4329 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4330
4331 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4332
4333
4334 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4335 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4336 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4337
4338 static void
4339 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4340 {
4341 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4342 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4343 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4344
4345 switch (cs->reason)
4346 {
4347 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4348 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4349 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4350 break;
4351
4352 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4353 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4354 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4355 break;
4356
4357 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4358 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4359 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4360 break;
4361
4362 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4363 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4364 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4365 break;
4366
4367 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4368 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4369 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4370 break;
4371
4372 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4373 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4374 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4375 break;
4376
4377 case XmCR_DRAG:
4378 {
4379 int slider_size;
4380
4381 /* Get the slider size. */
4382 BLOCK_INPUT;
4383 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4384 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4385
4386 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4387 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4388 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4389 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4390 }
4391 break;
4392
4393 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4394 break;
4395 };
4396
4397 if (part >= 0)
4398 {
4399 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4400 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4401 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4402 }
4403 }
4404
4405 #elif defined USE_GTK
4406
4407 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4408 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4409
4410 static gboolean
4411 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4412 GtkScrollType scroll,
4413 gdouble value,
4414 gpointer user_data)
4415 {
4416 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4417 gdouble position;
4418 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4419 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4420 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4421
4422 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4423 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4424
4425
4426 switch (scroll)
4427 {
4428 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4429 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4430 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4431 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4432 {
4433 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4434 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4435 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4436 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4437 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4438 }
4439 break;
4440 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4441 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4442 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4443 break;
4444 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4445 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4446 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4447 break;
4448 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4449 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4450 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4451 break;
4452 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4453 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4454 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4455 break;
4456 }
4457
4458 if (part >= 0)
4459 {
4460 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4461 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4462 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4463 }
4464
4465 return FALSE;
4466 }
4467
4468 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4469
4470 static gboolean
4471 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4472 GdkEventButton *event,
4473 gpointer user_data)
4474 {
4475 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4476 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4477 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4478 {
4479 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4480 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4481 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4482 }
4483
4484 return FALSE;
4485 }
4486
4487
4488 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4489
4490 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4491 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4492 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4493 the thumb is. */
4494
4495 static void
4496 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4497 {
4498 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4499 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4500 float shown;
4501 int whole, portion, height;
4502 int part;
4503
4504 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4505 BLOCK_INPUT;
4506 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4507 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4508
4509 whole = 10000000;
4510 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4511
4512 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4513 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4514 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4515 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4516 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4517 bottom). */
4518 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4519 else
4520 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4521
4522 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4523 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4524 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4525 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4526 }
4527
4528
4529 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4530 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4531 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4532 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4533 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4534 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4535 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4536
4537 static void
4538 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4539 {
4540 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4541 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4542 int position = (long) call_data;
4543 Dimension height;
4544 int part;
4545
4546 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4547 BLOCK_INPUT;
4548 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4549 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4550
4551 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4552 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4553
4554 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4555 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4556 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4557 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4558 else
4559 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4560
4561 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4562 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4563 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4564 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4565 }
4566
4567 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4568
4569 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4570
4571 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4572 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4573
4574 #ifdef USE_GTK
4575 static void
4576 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4577 {
4578 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4579
4580 BLOCK_INPUT;
4581 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4582 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4583 scroll_bar_name);
4584 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4585 }
4586
4587 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4588
4589 static void
4590 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4591 {
4592 Window xwindow;
4593 Widget widget;
4594 Arg av[20];
4595 int ac = 0;
4596 char const *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4597 unsigned long pixel;
4598
4599 BLOCK_INPUT;
4600
4601 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4602 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4603 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4604 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4605 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4606 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4607 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4608 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4609 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4610
4611 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4612 if (pixel != -1)
4613 {
4614 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4615 ++ac;
4616 }
4617
4618 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4619 if (pixel != -1)
4620 {
4621 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4622 ++ac;
4623 }
4624
4625 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4626 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4627
4628 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4629 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4630 (XtPointer) bar);
4631 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4632 (XtPointer) bar);
4633 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4634 (XtPointer) bar);
4635 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4636 (XtPointer) bar);
4637 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4638 (XtPointer) bar);
4639 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4640 (XtPointer) bar);
4641 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4642 (XtPointer) bar);
4643
4644 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4645 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4646
4647 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4648 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4649 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4650 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4651
4652 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4653
4654 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4655 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4656 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4657 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4658 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4659 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4660 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4661 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4662
4663 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4664 if (pixel != -1)
4665 {
4666 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4667 ++ac;
4668 }
4669
4670 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4671 if (pixel != -1)
4672 {
4673 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4674 ++ac;
4675 }
4676
4677 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4678
4679 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4680 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4681 {
4682 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4683 if (pixel != -1)
4684 {
4685 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4686 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4687 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4688 pixel = -1;
4689 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4690 }
4691 }
4692 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4693 {
4694 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4695 if (pixel != -1)
4696 {
4697 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4698 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4699 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4700 pixel = -1;
4701 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4702 }
4703 }
4704
4705 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4706 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4707 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4708 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4709 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4710 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4711 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4712 colors itself. */
4713 {
4714 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4715 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4716 ++ac;
4717 }
4718 else
4719 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4720 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4721 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4722 {
4723 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4724 the shadows. */
4725 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4726 ++ac;
4727
4728 /* Specify the colors. */
4729 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4730 if (pixel != -1)
4731 {
4732 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4733 ++ac;
4734 }
4735 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4736 if (pixel != -1)
4737 {
4738 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4739 ++ac;
4740 }
4741 }
4742 #endif
4743
4744 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4745 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4746
4747 {
4748 char const *initial = "";
4749 char const *val = initial;
4750 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4751 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4752 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4753 #endif
4754 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4755 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4756 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4757 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4758 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4759 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4760 }
4761 }
4762
4763 /* Define callbacks. */
4764 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4765 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4766 (XtPointer) bar);
4767
4768 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4769 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4770
4771 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4772
4773 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4774 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4775 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4776 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4777
4778 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4779 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4780 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4781 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4782
4783 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4784 }
4785 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4786
4787
4788 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4789 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4790
4791 #ifdef USE_GTK
4792 static void
4793 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4794 {
4795 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4796 }
4797
4798 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4799 static void
4800 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4801 int whole)
4802 {
4803 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4804 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4805 float top, shown;
4806
4807 BLOCK_INPUT;
4808
4809 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4810
4811 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4812 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4813 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4814 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4815 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4816 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4817 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4818 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4819 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4820 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4821 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4822 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4823 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4824 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4825 whole += portion;
4826
4827 if (whole <= 0)
4828 top = 0, shown = 1;
4829 else
4830 {
4831 top = (float) position / whole;
4832 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4833 }
4834
4835 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4836 {
4837 int size, value;
4838
4839 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4840 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4841 value. */
4842 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4843 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4844 size = max (size, 1);
4845
4846 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4847 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4848 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4849
4850 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4851 }
4852 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4853
4854 if (whole == 0)
4855 top = 0, shown = 1;
4856 else
4857 {
4858 top = (float) position / whole;
4859 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4860 }
4861
4862 {
4863 float old_top, old_shown;
4864 Dimension height;
4865 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4866 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4867 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4868 XtNheight, &height,
4869 NULL);
4870
4871 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4872 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4873 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4874 else
4875 top = old_top;
4876 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4877 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4878
4879 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4880 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4881 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4882 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4883 {
4884 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4885 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4886 else
4887 {
4888 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4889 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4890 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4891
4892 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4893 }
4894 }
4895 }
4896 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4897
4898 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4899 }
4900 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4901
4902 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4903
4904
4905 \f
4906 /************************************************************************
4907 Scroll bars, general
4908 ************************************************************************/
4909
4910 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4911 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4912 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4913 scroll bar. */
4914
4915 static struct scroll_bar *
4916 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4917 {
4918 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4919 struct scroll_bar *bar
4920 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4921
4922 BLOCK_INPUT;
4923
4924 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4925 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4926 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4927 {
4928 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4929 unsigned long mask;
4930 Window window;
4931
4932 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4933 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4934 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4935
4936 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4937 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4938 | ExposureMask);
4939 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4940
4941 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4942
4943 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4944 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4945 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4946 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4947 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4948 left, top, width,
4949 window_box_height (w), False);
4950
4951 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4952 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4953 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4954 top,
4955 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4956 height,
4957 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4958 0,
4959 CopyFromParent,
4960 CopyFromParent,
4961 CopyFromParent,
4962 /* Attributes. */
4963 mask, &a);
4964 bar->x_window = window;
4965 }
4966 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4967
4968 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4969 bar->top = top;
4970 bar->left = left;
4971 bar->width = width;
4972 bar->height = height;
4973 bar->start = 0;
4974 bar->end = 0;
4975 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4976 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4977
4978 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4979 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4980 bar->prev = Qnil;
4981 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4982 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4983 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4984
4985 /* Map the window/widget. */
4986 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4987 {
4988 #ifdef USE_GTK
4989 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4990 bar->x_window,
4991 top,
4992 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4993 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4994 max (height, 1));
4995 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4996 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4997 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4998 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4999 top,
5000 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5001 max (height, 1), 0);
5002 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5003 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5004 }
5005 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5006 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5007 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5008
5009 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5010 return bar;
5011 }
5012
5013
5014 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5015
5016 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5017
5018 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5019 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5020 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5021 events.)
5022
5023 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5024 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5025 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5026 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5027 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5028
5029 static void
5030 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
5031 {
5032 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5033 Window w = bar->x_window;
5034 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5035 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5036
5037 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5038 if (! rebuild
5039 && start == bar->start
5040 && end == bar->end)
5041 return;
5042
5043 BLOCK_INPUT;
5044
5045 {
5046 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5047 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5048 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5049
5050 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5051 the distance between start and end. */
5052 {
5053 int length = end - start;
5054
5055 if (start < 0)
5056 start = 0;
5057 else if (start > top_range)
5058 start = top_range;
5059 end = start + length;
5060
5061 if (end < start)
5062 end = start;
5063 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5064 end = top_range;
5065 }
5066
5067 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5068 bar->start = start;
5069 bar->end = end;
5070
5071 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5072 if (end > top_range)
5073 end = top_range;
5074
5075 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5076 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5077 that many pixels tall. */
5078 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5079
5080 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5081 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5082 if (0 < start)
5083 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5084 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5085 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5086 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5087 inside_width, start,
5088 False);
5089
5090 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5091 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5092 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5093 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5094
5095 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5096 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5097 /* x, y, width, height */
5098 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5099 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5100 inside_width, end - start);
5101
5102 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5103 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5104 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5105 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5106
5107 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5108 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5109 if (end < inside_height)
5110 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5111 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5112 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5113 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5114 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5115 False);
5116
5117 }
5118
5119 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5120 }
5121
5122 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5123
5124 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5125 nil. */
5126
5127 static void
5128 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5129 {
5130 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5131 BLOCK_INPUT;
5132
5133 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5134 #ifdef USE_GTK
5135 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5136 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5137 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5138 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5139 #else
5140 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5141 #endif
5142
5143 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5144 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5145
5146 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5147 }
5148
5149
5150 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5151 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5152 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5153 create one. */
5154
5155 static void
5156 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5157 {
5158 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5159 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5160 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5161 int window_y, window_height;
5162 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5163 int fringe_extended_p;
5164 #endif
5165
5166 /* Get window dimensions. */
5167 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5168 top = window_y;
5169 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5170 height = window_height;
5171
5172 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5173 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5174
5175 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5176 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5177 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5178 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5179 else
5180 sb_width = width;
5181
5182 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5183 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5184 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5185 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5186 else
5187 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5188 #else
5189 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5190 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5191 else
5192 sb_left = left;
5193 #endif
5194
5195 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5196 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5197 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5198 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5199 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5200 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5201 else
5202 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5203 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5204 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5205 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5206 #endif
5207
5208 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5209 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5210 {
5211 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5212 {
5213 BLOCK_INPUT;
5214 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5215 if (fringe_extended_p)
5216 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5217 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5218 else
5219 #endif
5220 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5221 left, top, width, height, False);
5222 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5223 }
5224
5225 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5226 }
5227 else
5228 {
5229 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5230 unsigned int mask = 0;
5231
5232 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5233
5234 BLOCK_INPUT;
5235
5236 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5237 mask |= CWX;
5238 if (top != bar->top)
5239 mask |= CWY;
5240 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5241 mask |= CWWidth;
5242 if (height != bar->height)
5243 mask |= CWHeight;
5244
5245 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5246
5247 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5248 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5249 {
5250 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5251 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5252 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5253 {
5254 if (fringe_extended_p)
5255 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5256 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5257 else
5258 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5259 left, top, width, height, False);
5260 }
5261 #ifdef USE_GTK
5262 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5263 bar->x_window,
5264 top,
5265 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5266 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5267 max (height, 1));
5268 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5269 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5270 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5271 top,
5272 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5273 max (height, 1), 0);
5274 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5275 }
5276 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5277
5278 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5279 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5280 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5281 {
5282 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5283 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5284 height, False);
5285 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5286 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5287 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5288 height, False);
5289 }
5290
5291 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5292 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5293 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5294 example. */
5295 {
5296 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5297 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5298 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5299 {
5300 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5301 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5302 left + area_width - rest, top,
5303 rest, height, False);
5304 else
5305 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5306 left, top, rest, height, False);
5307 }
5308 }
5309
5310 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5311 if (mask)
5312 {
5313 XWindowChanges wc;
5314
5315 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5316 wc.y = top;
5317 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5318 wc.height = height;
5319 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5320 mask, &wc);
5321 }
5322
5323 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5324
5325 /* Remember new settings. */
5326 bar->left = sb_left;
5327 bar->top = top;
5328 bar->width = sb_width;
5329 bar->height = height;
5330
5331 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5332 }
5333
5334 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5335 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5336
5337 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5338 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5339 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5340 dragged. */
5341 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5342 {
5343 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5344
5345 if (whole == 0)
5346 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5347 else
5348 {
5349 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5350 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5351 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5352 }
5353 }
5354 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5355
5356 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5357 }
5358
5359
5360 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5361 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5362 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5363 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5364 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5365 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5366 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5367
5368 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5369 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5370 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5371
5372 static void
5373 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5374 {
5375 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5376 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5377 {
5378 Lisp_Object bar;
5379 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5380 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5381 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5382 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5383 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5384 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5385 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5386 }
5387 }
5388
5389
5390 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5391 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5392
5393 static void
5394 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5395 {
5396 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5397 struct frame *f;
5398
5399 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5400 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5401 abort ();
5402
5403 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5404
5405 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5406 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5407 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5408 {
5409 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5410 the lists. */
5411 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5412 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5413 return;
5414 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5415 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5416 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5417 else
5418 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5419 one or the other! */
5420 abort ();
5421 }
5422 else
5423 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5424
5425 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5426 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5427
5428 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5429 bar->prev = Qnil;
5430 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5431 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5432 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5433 }
5434
5435 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5436 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5437
5438 static void
5439 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5440 {
5441 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5442
5443 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5444
5445 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5446 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5447 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5448
5449 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5450 {
5451 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5452
5453 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5454
5455 next = b->next;
5456 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5457 }
5458
5459 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5460 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5461 }
5462
5463
5464 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5465 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5466 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5467
5468 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5469 mark bits. */
5470
5471 static void
5472 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5473 {
5474 Window w = bar->x_window;
5475 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5476 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5477 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5478
5479 BLOCK_INPUT;
5480
5481 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5482
5483 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5484 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5485 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5486 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5487
5488 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5489 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5490
5491 /* x, y, width, height */
5492 0, 0,
5493 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5494 bar->height - 1);
5495
5496 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5497 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5498 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5499 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5500
5501 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5502
5503 }
5504 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5505
5506 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5507 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5508
5509 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5510 mark bits. */
5511
5512
5513 static void
5514 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5515 {
5516 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5517 abort ();
5518
5519 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5520 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5521 emacs_event->modifiers
5522 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5523 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5524 event->xbutton.state)
5525 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5526 ? up_modifier
5527 : down_modifier));
5528 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5529 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5530 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5531 {
5532 int top_range
5533 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5534 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5535
5536 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5537 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5538
5539 if (y < bar->start)
5540 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5541 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5542 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5543 else
5544 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5545
5546 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5547 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5548 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5549 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5550 {
5551 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5552 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5553
5554 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5555 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5556 }
5557 #endif
5558
5559 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5560 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5561 }
5562 }
5563
5564 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5565
5566 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5567
5568 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5569 mark bits. */
5570
5571 static void
5572 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5573 {
5574 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5575
5576 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5577
5578 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5579 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5580
5581 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5582 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5583 {
5584 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5585 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5586
5587 if (new_start != bar->start)
5588 {
5589 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5590
5591 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5592 }
5593 }
5594 }
5595
5596 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5597
5598 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5599 on the scroll bar. */
5600
5601 static void
5602 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5603 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5604 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
5605 {
5606 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5607 Window w = bar->x_window;
5608 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5609 int win_x, win_y;
5610 Window dummy_window;
5611 int dummy_coord;
5612 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5613
5614 BLOCK_INPUT;
5615
5616 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5617 report that. */
5618 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5619
5620 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5621 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5622 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5623
5624 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5625 &win_x, &win_y,
5626
5627 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5628 &dummy_mask))
5629 ;
5630 else
5631 {
5632 int top_range
5633 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5634
5635 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5636
5637 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5638 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5639
5640 if (win_y < 0)
5641 win_y = 0;
5642 if (win_y > top_range)
5643 win_y = top_range;
5644
5645 *fp = f;
5646 *bar_window = bar->window;
5647
5648 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5649 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5650 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5651 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5652 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5653 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5654 else
5655 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5656
5657 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5658 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5659
5660 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5661 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5662 }
5663
5664 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5665
5666 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5667 }
5668
5669
5670 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5671 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5672 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5673 redraw them. */
5674
5675 static void
5676 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5677 {
5678 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5679 Lisp_Object bar;
5680
5681 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5682 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5683 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5684 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5685 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5686 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5687 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5688 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5689 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5690 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5691 }
5692
5693 \f
5694 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5695
5696 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5697 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5698 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5699 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5700
5701 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5702 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5703
5704 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5705
5706 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5707 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5708
5709 static int temp_index;
5710 static short temp_buffer[100];
5711
5712 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5713 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5714 temp_index = 0; \
5715 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5716
5717 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5718 on a particular display. */
5719
5720 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5721
5722 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5723 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5724 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5725 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5726
5727 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5728
5729 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5730 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5731 do \
5732 { \
5733 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5734 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5735 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5736 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5737 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5738 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5739 } \
5740 while (0)
5741 #endif
5742
5743 enum
5744 {
5745 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5746 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5747 X_EVENT_DROP
5748 };
5749
5750 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5751 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5752 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5753
5754 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5755 this event further.
5756 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5757
5758 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5759 static int
5760 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5761 {
5762 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5763 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5764 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5765 was created. */
5766
5767 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5768 event->xclient.window);
5769
5770 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5771 }
5772 #endif
5773
5774 #ifdef USE_GTK
5775 static int current_count;
5776 static int current_finish;
5777 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5778
5779 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5780 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5781 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5782 static GdkFilterReturn
5783 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5784 {
5785 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5786
5787 BLOCK_INPUT;
5788 if (current_count >= 0)
5789 {
5790 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5791
5792 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5793
5794 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5795 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5796 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5797 so we do it here. */
5798 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5799 && dpyinfo
5800 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5801 {
5802 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5803 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5804 }
5805 #endif
5806
5807 if (! dpyinfo)
5808 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5809 else
5810 current_count +=
5811 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5812 current_hold_quit);
5813 }
5814 else
5815 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5816
5817 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5818
5819 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5820 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5821
5822 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5823 }
5824 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5825
5826
5827 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
5828 enum xembed_message,
5829 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5830
5831 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5832
5833 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5834 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5835 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5836
5837 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5838
5839 static int
5840 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5841 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5842 {
5843 union {
5844 struct input_event ie;
5845 struct selection_input_event sie;
5846 } inev;
5847 int count = 0;
5848 int do_help = 0;
5849 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
5850 struct frame *f = NULL;
5851 struct coding_system coding;
5852 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5853 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5854 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5855
5856 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5857
5858 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5859 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5860 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5861
5862 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5863 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5864
5865 switch (event.type)
5866 {
5867 case ClientMessage:
5868 {
5869 if (event.xclient.message_type
5870 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5871 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5872 {
5873 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5874 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5875 {
5876 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5877 could be the shell widget window
5878 if the frame has no title bar. */
5879 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5880 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5881 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5882 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5883 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5884 #endif
5885 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5886 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5887 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5888 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5889 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5890 needed.
5891
5892 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5893 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5894 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5895 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5896 Emacs. */
5897
5898 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5899 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5900 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5901 if (f)
5902 {
5903 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5904 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5905 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5906 x_catch_errors (d);
5907 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5908 /* The ICCCM says this is
5909 the only valid choice. */
5910 RevertToParent,
5911 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5912 /* This is needed to detect the error
5913 if there is an error. */
5914 XSync (d, False);
5915 x_uncatch_errors ();
5916 }
5917 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5918 #endif /* 0 */
5919 goto done;
5920 }
5921
5922 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5923 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5924 {
5925 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5926 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5927 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5928 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5929 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5930 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5931 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5932 session manager and one for this. */
5933 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5934 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5935 #endif
5936 {
5937 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5938 event.xclient.window);
5939 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5940 for a single Emacs process. */
5941 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5942 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5943 event.xclient.window,
5944 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5945 else if (f)
5946 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5947 event.xclient.window,
5948 0, 0);
5949 }
5950 goto done;
5951 }
5952
5953 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5954 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5955 {
5956 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5957 event.xclient.window);
5958 if (!f)
5959 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5960
5961 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5962 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5963 goto done;
5964 }
5965
5966 goto done;
5967 }
5968
5969 if (event.xclient.message_type
5970 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5971 {
5972 goto done;
5973 }
5974
5975 if (event.xclient.message_type
5976 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5977 {
5978 int new_x, new_y;
5979 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5980
5981 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5982 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5983
5984 if (f)
5985 {
5986 f->left_pos = new_x;
5987 f->top_pos = new_y;
5988 }
5989 goto done;
5990 }
5991
5992 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5993 if (event.xclient.message_type
5994 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5995 {
5996 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5997 if (f)
5998 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5999 &event, NULL);
6000 goto done;
6001 }
6002 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6003
6004 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6005 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6006 || (event.xclient.message_type
6007 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6008 {
6009 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6010 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6011 currently never do because we are interested in
6012 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6013 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6014 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6015 if (!f)
6016 goto OTHER;
6017 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6018 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6019 goto done;
6020 }
6021
6022 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6023 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6024 we construct an input_event. */
6025 if (event.xclient.message_type
6026 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6027 {
6028 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6029 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6030 goto done;
6031 }
6032 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6033
6034 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6035 if (event.xclient.message_type
6036 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6037 {
6038 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6039 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6040 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6041
6042 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6043 goto done;
6044 }
6045
6046 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6047
6048 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6049 if (!f)
6050 goto OTHER;
6051 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6052 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6053 }
6054 break;
6055
6056 case SelectionNotify:
6057 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6058 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6059 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6060 goto OTHER;
6061 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6062 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6063 break;
6064
6065 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6066 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6067 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6068 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6069 goto OTHER;
6070 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6071 {
6072 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionclear);
6073
6074 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6075 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6076 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6077 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6078 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6079 }
6080 break;
6081
6082 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6083 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6084 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6085 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6086 goto OTHER;
6087 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6088 {
6089 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionrequest);
6090
6091 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6092 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6093 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6094 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6095 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6096 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6097 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6098 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6099 }
6100 break;
6101
6102 case PropertyNotify:
6103 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6104 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6105 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6106 x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty);
6107
6108 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6109 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6110 goto OTHER;
6111
6112 case ReparentNotify:
6113 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6114 if (f)
6115 {
6116 int x, y;
6117 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6118 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6119 f->left_pos = x;
6120 f->top_pos = y;
6121
6122 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6123 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6124 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6125
6126 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6127 }
6128 goto OTHER;
6129
6130 case Expose:
6131 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6132 if (f)
6133 {
6134 #ifdef USE_GTK
6135 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6136 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6137 event.xexpose.window,
6138 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6139 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6140 FALSE);
6141 #endif
6142 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6143 {
6144 f->async_visible = 1;
6145 f->async_iconified = 0;
6146 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6147 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6148 }
6149 else
6150 expose_frame (f,
6151 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6152 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6153 }
6154 else
6155 {
6156 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6157 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6158 #endif
6159 #if defined USE_LUCID
6160 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6161 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6162 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6163 {
6164 Widget widget
6165 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6166 if (widget)
6167 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6168 }
6169 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6170
6171 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6172 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6173 goto OTHER;
6174 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6175 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6176 event.xexpose.window);
6177
6178 if (bar)
6179 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6180 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6181 else
6182 goto OTHER;
6183 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6184 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6185 }
6186 break;
6187
6188 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6189 source area was obscured or not
6190 available. */
6191 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6192 if (f)
6193 {
6194 expose_frame (f,
6195 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6196 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6197 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6198 }
6199 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6200 else
6201 goto OTHER;
6202 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6203 break;
6204
6205 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6206 source area was completely
6207 available. */
6208 break;
6209
6210 case UnmapNotify:
6211 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6212 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6213 {
6214 tip_window = 0;
6215 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6216 }
6217
6218 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6219 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6220 the frame was deleted. */
6221 {
6222 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6223 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6224 display that won't ever be seen. */
6225 f->async_visible = 0;
6226 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6227 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6228 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6229 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6230 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6231 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6232 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6233 {
6234 f->async_iconified = 1;
6235
6236 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6237 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6238 }
6239 }
6240 goto OTHER;
6241
6242 case MapNotify:
6243 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6244 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6245 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6246 goto OTHER;
6247
6248 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6249 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6250 frame is visible. */
6251 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6252 if (f)
6253 {
6254 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6255 the frame's display structures.
6256 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6257 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6258 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6259 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6260 if (! f->async_iconified)
6261 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6262
6263 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6264 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6265 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6266 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6267
6268 f->async_visible = 1;
6269 f->async_iconified = 0;
6270 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6271
6272 if (f->iconified)
6273 {
6274 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6275 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6276 }
6277 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6278 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6279 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6280 to update the frame titles
6281 in case this is the second frame. */
6282 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6283
6284 #ifdef USE_GTK
6285 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6286 #endif
6287 }
6288 goto OTHER;
6289
6290 case KeyPress:
6291
6292 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6293 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6294
6295 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6296 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6297 if (popup_activated ())
6298 goto OTHER;
6299 #endif
6300
6301 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6302
6303 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6304 mouse highlighting. */
6305 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6306 && (f == 0
6307 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6308 {
6309 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6310 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6311 }
6312
6313 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6314 if (f == 0)
6315 {
6316 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6317 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6318 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6319 event.xkey.window);
6320 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6321 {
6322 widget = XtParent (widget);
6323 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6324 }
6325 }
6326 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6327
6328 if (f != 0)
6329 {
6330 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6331 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6332 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6333 his Emacs hang.
6334
6335 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6336 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6337 status_return even if the input is too long to
6338 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6339 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6340 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6341 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6342 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6343 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6344 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6345 int modifiers;
6346 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6347 Lisp_Object c;
6348
6349 #ifdef USE_GTK
6350 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6351 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6352 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6353 (see above). */
6354 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6355 #endif
6356
6357 event.xkey.state
6358 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6359 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6360 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6361
6362 /* This will have to go some day... */
6363
6364 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6365 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6366 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6367 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6368 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6369 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6370 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6371
6372 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6373 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6374 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6375 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6376 not it is combined with Meta. */
6377 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6378 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6379
6380 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6381 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6382 {
6383 Status status_return;
6384
6385 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6386 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6387 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6388 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6389 &status_return);
6390 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6391 {
6392 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6393 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6394 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6395 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6396 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6397 &status_return);
6398 }
6399 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6400 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6401 break;
6402 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6403 {
6404 keysym = NoSymbol;
6405 modifiers = 0;
6406 }
6407 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6408 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6409 abort ();
6410 }
6411 else
6412 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6413 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6414 &compose_status);
6415 #else
6416 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6417 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6418 &compose_status);
6419 #endif
6420
6421 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6422 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6423 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6424 break;
6425
6426 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6427 orig_keysym = keysym;
6428
6429 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6430 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6431 inev.ie.modifiers
6432 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6433 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6434
6435 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6436 translations to characters. */
6437 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6438 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6439 {
6440 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6441 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6442 goto done_keysym;
6443 }
6444
6445 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6446 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6447 {
6448 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6449 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6450 else
6451 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6452 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6453 goto done_keysym;
6454 }
6455
6456 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6457 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6458 && (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6459 Vx_keysym_table,
6460 Qnil),
6461 NATNUMP (c)))
6462 {
6463 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6464 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6465 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6466 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6467 goto done_keysym;
6468 }
6469
6470 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6471 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6472 || keysym == XK_Delete
6473 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6474 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6475 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6476 #endif
6477 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6478 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6479 #ifdef HPUX
6480 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6481 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6482 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6483 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6484 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
6485 #endif
6486 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6487 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6488 #endif
6489 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6490 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6491 #endif
6492 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6493 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6494 #endif
6495 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6496 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6497 #endif
6498 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6499 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6500 #endif
6501 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6502 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6503 #endif
6504 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6505 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6506 #endif
6507 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6508 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6509 #endif
6510 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6511 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6512 #endif
6513 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6514 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6515 #endif
6516 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6517 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6518 #endif
6519 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6520 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6521 #endif
6522 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6523 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6524 #endif
6525 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6526 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6527 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6528 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6529 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6530 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6531 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6532 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6533 don't have real modifiers but
6534 should be treated similarly to
6535 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6536 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6537 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
6538 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6539 #endif
6540 ))
6541 {
6542 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6543 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6544 key. */
6545 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6546 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6547 goto done_keysym;
6548 }
6549
6550 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6551 ptrdiff_t i;
6552 int nchars, len;
6553
6554 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6555 {
6556 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6557 nchars++;
6558 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6559 }
6560
6561 if (nchars < nbytes)
6562 {
6563 /* Decode the input data. */
6564
6565 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6566 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6567 we used just above and the locale. */
6568 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6569 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6570 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6571 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6572 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6573 gives us composition information. */
6574 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6575
6576 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
6577 nbytes);
6578 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6579 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6580 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6581 nbytes = coding.produced;
6582 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6583 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6584 }
6585
6586 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6587 character events. */
6588 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6589 {
6590 int ch;
6591 if (nchars == nbytes)
6592 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6593 else
6594 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6595 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6596 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6597 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6598 inev.ie.code = ch;
6599 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6600 }
6601
6602 count += nchars;
6603
6604 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6605
6606 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6607 break;
6608 }
6609 }
6610 done_keysym:
6611 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6612 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6613 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6614 client. */
6615 break;
6616 #else
6617 goto OTHER;
6618 #endif
6619
6620 case KeyRelease:
6621 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6622 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6623 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6624 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6625 client. */
6626 break;
6627 #else
6628 goto OTHER;
6629 #endif
6630
6631 case EnterNotify:
6632 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6633 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6634
6635 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6636
6637 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6638 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6639
6640 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6641 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6642 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6643 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6644 #ifdef USE_GTK
6645 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6646 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6647 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6648 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6649 #endif
6650 goto OTHER;
6651
6652 case FocusIn:
6653 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6654 goto OTHER;
6655
6656 case LeaveNotify:
6657 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6658 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6659
6660 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6661 if (f)
6662 {
6663 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6664 {
6665 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6666 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6667 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6668 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6669 }
6670
6671 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6672 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6673 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6674 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6675 if (any_help_event_p)
6676 do_help = -1;
6677 }
6678 #ifdef USE_GTK
6679 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6680 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6681 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6682 #endif
6683 goto OTHER;
6684
6685 case FocusOut:
6686 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6687 goto OTHER;
6688
6689 case MotionNotify:
6690 {
6691 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6692 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6693 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6694
6695 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6696 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6697 f = last_mouse_frame;
6698 else
6699 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6700
6701 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6702 {
6703 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6704 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6705 }
6706
6707 #ifdef USE_GTK
6708 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6709 f = 0;
6710 #endif
6711 if (f)
6712 {
6713
6714 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6715 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6716 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6717 {
6718 Lisp_Object window;
6719
6720 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6721 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6722 0, 0);
6723
6724 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6725 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6726 will be selected only when it is active. */
6727 if (WINDOWP (window)
6728 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6729 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6730 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6731 create event iff we don't leave the
6732 selected frame. */
6733 && (focus_follows_mouse
6734 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6735 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6736 {
6737 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6738 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6739 }
6740
6741 last_window=window;
6742 }
6743 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6744 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6745 }
6746 else
6747 {
6748 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6749 struct scroll_bar *bar
6750 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6751 event.xmotion.window);
6752
6753 if (bar)
6754 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6755 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6756
6757 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6758 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6759 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6760 }
6761
6762 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6763 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6764 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6765 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6766 do_help = 1;
6767 goto OTHER;
6768 }
6769
6770 case ConfigureNotify:
6771 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6772 #ifdef USE_GTK
6773 if (!f
6774 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6775 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6776 {
6777 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6778 event.xconfigure.height);
6779 f = 0;
6780 }
6781 #endif
6782 if (f)
6783 {
6784 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6785 #ifndef USE_GTK
6786 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6787 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6788
6789 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6790 is called by the code that handles resizing
6791 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6792
6793 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6794 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6795 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6796 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6797 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6798 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6799 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6800 {
6801 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6802 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6803 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6804 }
6805
6806 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6807 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6808 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6809 #endif
6810
6811 #ifdef USE_GTK
6812 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6813 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6814 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6815 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6816 #endif
6817 {
6818 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6819 }
6820
6821 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6822 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6823 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6824 #endif
6825
6826 }
6827 goto OTHER;
6828
6829 case ButtonRelease:
6830 case ButtonPress:
6831 {
6832 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6833 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6834 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6835
6836 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6837 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6838 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6839
6840 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6841 && last_mouse_frame
6842 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6843 f = last_mouse_frame;
6844 else
6845 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6846
6847 #ifdef USE_GTK
6848 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6849 f = 0;
6850 #endif
6851 if (f)
6852 {
6853 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6854 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6855 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6856 {
6857 Lisp_Object window;
6858 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6859 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6860
6861 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6862 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6863
6864 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6865 {
6866 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6867 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6868 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6869 event.xbutton.state));
6870 }
6871 }
6872
6873 if (!tool_bar_p)
6874 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6875 if (! popup_activated ())
6876 #endif
6877 {
6878 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6879 {
6880 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6881 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6882 {
6883 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6884 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6885 }
6886 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6887 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6888 }
6889 else
6890 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6891 }
6892 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6893 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6894 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6895 }
6896 else
6897 {
6898 struct scroll_bar *bar
6899 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6900 event.xbutton.window);
6901
6902 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6903 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6904 scroll bars. */
6905 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6906 {
6907 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6908 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6909 }
6910 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6911 if (bar)
6912 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6913 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6914 }
6915
6916 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6917 {
6918 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6919 last_mouse_frame = f;
6920
6921 if (!tool_bar_p)
6922 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6923 }
6924 else
6925 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6926
6927 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6928 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6929 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6930 if (f != 0)
6931 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6932
6933 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6934 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6935 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6936 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6937 Instead, save it away
6938 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6939 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6940 if (! popup_activated ()
6941 #ifdef USE_GTK
6942 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6943 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6944 #endif
6945 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6946 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6947 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6948 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6949 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6950 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6951 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6952 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6953 {
6954 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6955 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6956 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6957 }
6958 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6959 {
6960 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6961 goto OTHER;
6962 }
6963 else
6964 goto OTHER;
6965 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6966 }
6967 break;
6968
6969 case CirculateNotify:
6970 goto OTHER;
6971
6972 case CirculateRequest:
6973 goto OTHER;
6974
6975 case VisibilityNotify:
6976 goto OTHER;
6977
6978 case MappingNotify:
6979 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6980 local cache. */
6981 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6982 {
6983 case MappingModifier:
6984 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6985 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6986 case MappingKeyboard:
6987 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6988 }
6989 goto OTHER;
6990
6991 case DestroyNotify:
6992 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6993 break;
6994
6995 default:
6996 OTHER:
6997 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6998 BLOCK_INPUT;
6999 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7000 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7001 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7002 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7003 break;
7004 }
7005
7006 done:
7007 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7008 {
7009 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7010 count++;
7011 }
7012
7013 if (do_help
7014 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7015 {
7016 Lisp_Object frame;
7017
7018 if (f)
7019 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7020 else
7021 frame = Qnil;
7022
7023 if (do_help > 0)
7024 {
7025 any_help_event_p = 1;
7026 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7027 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7028 }
7029 else
7030 {
7031 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7032 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7033 }
7034 count++;
7035 }
7036
7037 SAFE_FREE ();
7038 *eventptr = event;
7039 return count;
7040 }
7041
7042 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7043
7044 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7045 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7046 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7047
7048 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7049 int
7050 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7051 {
7052 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7053 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7054
7055 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7056
7057 if (dpyinfo)
7058 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7059
7060 return finish;
7061 }
7062 #endif
7063
7064
7065 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7066 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
7067 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7068
7069 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7070 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7071 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7072 C chars).
7073
7074 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7075
7076 static int
7077 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, int expected, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7078 {
7079 int count = 0;
7080 int event_found = 0;
7081
7082 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7083 {
7084 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7085 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7086 pending_signals = 1;
7087 #endif
7088 return -1;
7089 }
7090
7091 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7092 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7093 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
7094 #endif
7095 BLOCK_INPUT;
7096
7097 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7098 input_signal_count++;
7099
7100 ++handling_signal;
7101
7102 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7103 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7104 {
7105 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7106 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7107 }
7108
7109 #ifndef USE_GTK
7110 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7111 {
7112 int finish;
7113 XEvent event;
7114
7115 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7116
7117 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7118 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7119 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7120 continue;
7121 #endif
7122 event_found = 1;
7123
7124 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7125 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7126
7127 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7128 goto out;
7129 }
7130
7131 out:;
7132
7133 #else /* USE_GTK */
7134
7135 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7136 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7137 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7138 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7139
7140 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7141 from all displays. */
7142
7143 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7144 {
7145 current_count = count;
7146 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7147
7148 gtk_main_iteration ();
7149
7150 count = current_count;
7151 current_count = -1;
7152 current_hold_quit = 0;
7153
7154 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7155 break;
7156 }
7157 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7158
7159 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7160 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7161 if (! event_found)
7162 {
7163 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7164 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7165 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7166 x_noop_count++;
7167 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7168 {
7169 x_noop_count=0;
7170
7171 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7172 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7173
7174 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7175
7176 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7177 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7178 }
7179 }
7180
7181 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7182 raise it now. */
7183 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7184 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7185 {
7186 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7187 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7188 }
7189
7190 --handling_signal;
7191 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7192
7193 return count;
7194 }
7195
7196
7197
7198 \f
7199 /***********************************************************************
7200 Text Cursor
7201 ***********************************************************************/
7202
7203 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7204 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7205
7206 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7207 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7208 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7209
7210 static void
7211 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7212 {
7213 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7214 XRectangle clip_rect;
7215 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7216
7217 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7218
7219 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7220 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7221 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7222 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7223 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7224
7225 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7226 }
7227
7228
7229 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7230
7231 static void
7232 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7233 {
7234 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7235 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7236 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7237 int x, y, wd, h;
7238 XGCValues xgcv;
7239 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7240 GC gc;
7241
7242 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7243 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7244 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7245 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7246 return;
7247
7248 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7249 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7250 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7251
7252 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7253 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7254 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7255 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7256 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7257 else
7258 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7259 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7260 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7261
7262 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7263 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7264 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7265 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7266 }
7267
7268
7269 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7270
7271 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7272 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7273 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7274 --gerd. */
7275
7276 static void
7277 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7278 {
7279 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7280 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7281
7282 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7283 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7284 and mini-buffer. */
7285 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7286 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7287 return;
7288
7289 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7290 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7291 the bar might not be in the window. */
7292 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7293 {
7294 struct glyph_row *r;
7295 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7296 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7297 }
7298 else
7299 {
7300 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7301 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7302 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7303 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7304 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7305 XGCValues xgcv;
7306
7307 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7308 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7309 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7310 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7311 that the glyph is legible. */
7312 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7313 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7314 else
7315 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7316 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7317
7318 if (gc)
7319 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7320 else
7321 {
7322 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7323 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7324 }
7325
7326 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7327
7328 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7329 {
7330 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7331
7332 if (width < 0)
7333 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7334 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7335
7336 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7337
7338 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7339 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7340 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7341 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7342
7343 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7344 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7345 width, row->height);
7346 }
7347 else
7348 {
7349 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7350
7351 if (width < 0)
7352 width = row->height;
7353
7354 width = min (row->height, width);
7355
7356 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7357 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7358
7359 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7360 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7361 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7362 row->height - width),
7363 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7364 }
7365
7366 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7367 }
7368 }
7369
7370
7371 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7372
7373 static void
7374 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7375 {
7376 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7377 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7378 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7379 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7380 }
7381
7382
7383 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7384
7385 static void
7386 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7387 {
7388 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7389 x, y, width, height, False);
7390 #ifdef USE_GTK
7391 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7392 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7393 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7394 #endif
7395 }
7396
7397
7398 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7399
7400 static void
7401 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7402 {
7403 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7404
7405 if (on_p)
7406 {
7407 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7408 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7409
7410 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7411 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7412 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7413 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7414 {
7415 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7416 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7417 }
7418 else
7419 {
7420 switch (cursor_type)
7421 {
7422 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7423 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7424 break;
7425
7426 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7427 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7428 break;
7429
7430 case BAR_CURSOR:
7431 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7432 break;
7433
7434 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7435 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7436 break;
7437
7438 case NO_CURSOR:
7439 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7440 break;
7441
7442 default:
7443 abort ();
7444 }
7445 }
7446
7447 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7448 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7449 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7450 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7451 #endif
7452 }
7453
7454 #ifndef XFlush
7455 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7456 #endif
7457 }
7458
7459 \f
7460 /* Icons. */
7461
7462 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7463
7464 int
7465 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7466 {
7467 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
7468
7469 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7470 return 1;
7471
7472 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7473 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7474 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7475 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7476
7477 if (STRINGP (file))
7478 {
7479 #ifdef USE_GTK
7480 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7481 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7482 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7483 return 0;
7484 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7485 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7486 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7487 }
7488 else
7489 {
7490 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7491 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7492 {
7493 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
7494
7495 #ifdef USE_GTK
7496
7497 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7498 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7499 return 0;
7500
7501 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7502
7503 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7504 if (rc != -1)
7505 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7506
7507 #endif
7508
7509 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7510 if (rc == -1)
7511 {
7512 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7513 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7514 if (rc == -1)
7515 return 1;
7516
7517 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7518 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7519 }
7520 }
7521
7522 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7523 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7524 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7525 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7526 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7527
7528 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7529 }
7530
7531 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7532 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7533
7534 return 0;
7535 }
7536
7537
7538 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7539 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7540
7541 int
7542 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7543 {
7544 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7545 return 1;
7546
7547 {
7548 XTextProperty text;
7549 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7550 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7551 text.format = 8;
7552 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7553 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7554 }
7555
7556 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7557 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7558 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7559 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7560
7561 return 0;
7562 }
7563 \f
7564 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7565
7566 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7567 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7568
7569 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7570 be called from a signal handler.
7571 */
7572
7573 struct x_error_message_stack {
7574 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7575 Display *dpy;
7576 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7577 };
7578 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7579
7580 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7581 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7582 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7583
7584 static void
7585 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7586 {
7587 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7588 x_error_message->string,
7589 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7590 }
7591
7592 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7593 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7594 operating on.
7595
7596 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7597 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7598 stored in *x_error_message.
7599
7600 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7601 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7602
7603 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7604
7605 void
7606 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7607 {
7608 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7609
7610 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7611 XSync (dpy, False);
7612
7613 data->dpy = dpy;
7614 data->string[0] = 0;
7615 data->prev = x_error_message;
7616 x_error_message = data;
7617 }
7618
7619 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7620 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7621
7622 void
7623 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7624 {
7625 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7626
7627 BLOCK_INPUT;
7628
7629 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7630 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7631 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7632 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7633
7634 tmp = x_error_message;
7635 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7636 xfree (tmp);
7637 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7638 }
7639
7640 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7641 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7642 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7643
7644 void
7645 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7646 {
7647 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7648 XSync (dpy, False);
7649
7650 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7651 {
7652 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7653 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7654 x_uncatch_errors ();
7655 error (format, string);
7656 }
7657 }
7658
7659 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7660 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7661
7662 int
7663 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7664 {
7665 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7666 XSync (dpy, False);
7667
7668 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7669 }
7670
7671 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7672
7673 void
7674 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7675 {
7676 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7677 }
7678
7679 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7680 * idea. --lorentey */
7681 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7682
7683 void
7684 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7685 {
7686 while (x_error_message)
7687 x_uncatch_errors ();
7688 }
7689 #endif
7690
7691 #if 0
7692 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7693 x_trace_wire (void)
7694 {
7695 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7696 }
7697 #endif /* ! 0 */
7698
7699 \f
7700 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7701 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7702 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7703 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7704 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7705
7706 static void
7707 x_connection_signal (int signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7708 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7709 {
7710 #ifdef USG
7711 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7712 must reestablish each time */
7713 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7714 #endif /* USG */
7715 }
7716
7717 \f
7718 /************************************************************************
7719 Handling X errors
7720 ************************************************************************/
7721
7722 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7723
7724 static char *error_msg;
7725
7726 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7727 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7728
7729 static void
7730 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7731 {
7732 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7733 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7734 ptrdiff_t idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7735
7736 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7737 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7738 handling_signal = 0;
7739
7740 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7741 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7742
7743 if (dpyinfo)
7744 {
7745 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7746 frame on it. */
7747 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7748 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7749 }
7750
7751 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7752 that are on the dead display. */
7753 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7754 {
7755 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7756 minibuf_frame
7757 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7758 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7759 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7760 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7761 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7762 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7763 }
7764
7765 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7766 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7767 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7768 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7769 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7770 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7771 {
7772 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7773 trying to find a replacement. */
7774 KVAR (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Vdefault_minibuffer_frame) = Qt;
7775 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7776 }
7777
7778 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7779 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7780 if (dpyinfo)
7781 {
7782 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7783 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7784 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7785 #ifdef USE_GTK
7786 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7787 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7788 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7789 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7790 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7791 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7792 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7793 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7794 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7795 error_msg);
7796 abort ();
7797 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7798
7799 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7800 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7801
7802 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7803 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7804 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7805 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7806 abort ();
7807
7808 {
7809 Lisp_Object tmp;
7810 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7811 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7812 }
7813 }
7814
7815 if (terminal_list == 0)
7816 {
7817 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7818 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7819 /* NOTREACHED */
7820 }
7821
7822 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7823 #ifdef SIGIO
7824 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7825 #endif
7826 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7827 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7828
7829 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7830 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7831
7832 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7833 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7834
7835 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7836 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7837 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7838 error ("%s", error_msg);
7839 }
7840
7841 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7842 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7843 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7844
7845 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7846 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7847
7848 static int
7849 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7850 {
7851 if (x_error_message)
7852 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7853 else
7854 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7855 return 0;
7856 }
7857
7858 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7859 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7860 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7861
7862 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7863
7864 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7865 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7866
7867 static void NO_INLINE
7868 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7869 {
7870 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7871
7872 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7873 or colors that are not defined. */
7874
7875 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7876 return;
7877
7878 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7879 original error handler. */
7880
7881 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7882 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7883 buf, event->request_code);
7884 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7885 }
7886
7887
7888 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7889 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7890 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7891
7892 static int
7893 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7894 {
7895 char buf[256];
7896
7897 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
7898 DisplayString (display));
7899 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7900 return 0;
7901 }
7902 \f
7903 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7904
7905 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7906 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7907 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7908 FONT-OBJECT. */
7909
7910 Lisp_Object
7911 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7912 {
7913 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7914
7915 if (fontset < 0)
7916 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7917 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7918 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7919 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7920 do. */
7921 return font_object;
7922
7923 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7924 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7925 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7926 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
7927 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7928
7929 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7930
7931 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7932 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7933 {
7934 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7935 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7936 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7937 }
7938 else
7939 {
7940 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7941 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7942 }
7943
7944 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7945 {
7946 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7947 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7948 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7949 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7950 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7951 }
7952
7953 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7954 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7955 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7956 {
7957 BLOCK_INPUT;
7958 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7959 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7960 }
7961 #endif
7962
7963 return font_object;
7964 }
7965
7966 \f
7967 /***********************************************************************
7968 X Input Methods
7969 ***********************************************************************/
7970
7971 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7972
7973 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7974
7975 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7976 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7977 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7978
7979 static void
7980 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7981 {
7982 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7983 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7984
7985 BLOCK_INPUT;
7986
7987 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7988 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7989 {
7990 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7991 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7992 {
7993 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7994 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7995 }
7996 }
7997
7998 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7999 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8000 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8001 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8002 }
8003
8004 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8005
8006 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8007 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8008 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
8009 #endif
8010
8011 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8012 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8013
8014 static void
8015 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8016 {
8017 XIM xim;
8018
8019 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8020 if (use_xim)
8021 {
8022 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8023 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8024 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8025 emacs_class);
8026 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8027
8028 if (xim)
8029 {
8030 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8031 XIMCallback destroy;
8032 #endif
8033
8034 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8035 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8036
8037 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8038 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8039 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8040 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8041 #endif
8042 }
8043 }
8044
8045 else
8046 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8047 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8048 }
8049
8050
8051 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8052
8053 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8054 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8055 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8056 when the callback was registered. */
8057
8058 static void
8059 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8060 {
8061 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8062 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8063
8064 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8065 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8066 return;
8067
8068 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8069
8070 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8071 as they have no XIC. */
8072 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8073 {
8074 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8075
8076 BLOCK_INPUT;
8077 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8078 {
8079 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8080
8081 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8082 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8083 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8084 {
8085 create_frame_xic (f);
8086 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8087 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8088 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8089 {
8090 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8091 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8092 }
8093 }
8094 }
8095
8096 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8097 }
8098 }
8099
8100 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8101
8102
8103 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8104 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8105 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8106 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8107
8108 static void
8109 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8110 {
8111 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8112 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8113 if (use_xim)
8114 {
8115 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8116 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8117 ptrdiff_t len;
8118
8119 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8120 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8121 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8122 len = strlen (resource_name);
8123 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8124 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8125 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8126 resource_name, emacs_class,
8127 xim_instantiate_callback,
8128 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8129 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8130 least, hence the configure test. */
8131 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8132 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8133 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8134 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8135 }
8136 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8137 }
8138
8139
8140 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8141
8142 static void
8143 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8144 {
8145 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8146 if (use_xim)
8147 {
8148 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8149 if (dpyinfo->display)
8150 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8151 NULL, emacs_class,
8152 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8153 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8154 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8155 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8156 if (dpyinfo->display)
8157 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8158 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8159 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8160 }
8161 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8162 }
8163
8164 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8165
8166
8167 \f
8168 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8169 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8170
8171 static void
8172 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8173 {
8174 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8175
8176 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8177 is already for the top-left corner. */
8178 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8179 return;
8180
8181 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8182 position that fits on the screen. */
8183 if (flags & XNegative)
8184 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8185 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8186
8187 {
8188 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8189
8190 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8191 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8192 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8193
8194 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8195 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8196 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8197 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8198 is right, though.
8199
8200 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8201 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8202
8203 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8204 #endif
8205
8206 if (flags & YNegative)
8207 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8208 - height + f->top_pos;
8209 }
8210
8211 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8212 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8213 so the flags should correspond. */
8214 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8215 }
8216
8217 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8218 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8219 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8220 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8221 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8222
8223 void
8224 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8225 {
8226 int modified_top, modified_left;
8227
8228 if (change_gravity > 0)
8229 {
8230 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8231 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8232
8233 f->top_pos = yoff;
8234 f->left_pos = xoff;
8235 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8236 if (xoff < 0)
8237 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8238 if (yoff < 0)
8239 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8240 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8241 }
8242 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8243
8244 BLOCK_INPUT;
8245 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8246
8247 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8248 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8249
8250 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8251 {
8252 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8253 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8254 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8255 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8256 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8257 }
8258
8259 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8260 modified_left, modified_top);
8261
8262 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8263 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8264 ? 1 : 0);
8265
8266 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8267 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8268 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8269 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8270 of the frame.
8271
8272 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8273 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8274 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8275
8276 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8277 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8278 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8279 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8280 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8281 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8282
8283 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8284 }
8285
8286 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8287 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8288 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8289 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8290 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8291
8292 static int
8293 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8294 {
8295 Atom actual_type;
8296 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8297 int i, rc, actual_format;
8298 Window wmcheck_window;
8299 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8300 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8301 long max_len = 65536;
8302 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8303 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8304 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8305
8306 BLOCK_INPUT;
8307
8308 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8309 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8310 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8311 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8312 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8313 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8314
8315 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8316 {
8317 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8318 x_uncatch_errors ();
8319 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8320 return 0;
8321 }
8322
8323 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8324 XFree (tmp_data);
8325
8326 /* Check if window exists. */
8327 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8328 x_sync (f);
8329 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8330 {
8331 x_uncatch_errors ();
8332 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8333 return 0;
8334 }
8335
8336 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8337 {
8338 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8339 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8340 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8341 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8342 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8343 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8344
8345 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8346 tmp_data = NULL;
8347 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8348 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8349 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8350 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8351 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8352
8353 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8354 {
8355 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8356 x_uncatch_errors ();
8357 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8358 return 0;
8359 }
8360
8361 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8362 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8363 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8364 }
8365
8366 rc = 0;
8367
8368 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8369 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8370
8371 x_uncatch_errors ();
8372 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8373
8374 return rc;
8375 }
8376
8377 static void
8378 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8379 {
8380 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8381
8382 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8383 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8384 make_number (32),
8385 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8386 Fcons
8387 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8388 Fcons
8389 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8390 value != 0
8391 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8392 : Qnil)));
8393 }
8394
8395 void
8396 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8397 {
8398 Lisp_Object frame;
8399 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8400
8401 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8402
8403 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8404 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8405 }
8406
8407 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8408 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8409 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not. */
8410
8411 static void
8412 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8413 Window window,
8414 int *size_state,
8415 int *sticky)
8416 {
8417 Atom actual_type;
8418 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8419 int i, rc, actual_format;
8420 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8421 long max_len = 65536;
8422 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8423 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8424 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8425
8426 *sticky = 0;
8427 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8428
8429 BLOCK_INPUT;
8430 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8431 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8432 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8433 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8434 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8435
8436 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8437 {
8438 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8439 x_uncatch_errors ();
8440 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8441 return;
8442 }
8443
8444 x_uncatch_errors ();
8445
8446 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8447 {
8448 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8449 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8450 {
8451 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8452 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8453 else
8454 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8455 }
8456 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8457 {
8458 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8459 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8460 else
8461 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8462 }
8463 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8464 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8465 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8466 *sticky = 1;
8467 }
8468
8469 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8470 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8471 }
8472
8473 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8474
8475 static int
8476 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8477 {
8478 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8479 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8480 int cur, dummy;
8481
8482 get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8483
8484 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8485 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8486 if (!have_net_atom)
8487 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8488
8489 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8490 {
8491 Lisp_Object frame;
8492
8493 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8494
8495 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8496 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8497 are sent at once. */
8498 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8499 {
8500 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8501 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8502 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8503 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8504 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8505 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8506 break;
8507 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8508 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8509 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8510 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8511 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8512 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8513 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8514 break;
8515 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8516 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8517 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8518 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8519 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8520 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8521 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8522 break;
8523 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8524 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8525 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8526 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8527 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8528 break;
8529 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8530 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8531 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8532 else
8533 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8534 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8535 }
8536
8537 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8538
8539 }
8540
8541 return have_net_atom;
8542 }
8543
8544 static void
8545 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8546 {
8547 if (f->async_visible)
8548 {
8549 BLOCK_INPUT;
8550 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8551 x_sync (f);
8552 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8553 }
8554 }
8555
8556
8557 static void
8558 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8559 {
8560 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8561 Lisp_Object lval;
8562 int sticky = 0;
8563
8564 get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8565 lval = Qnil;
8566 switch (value)
8567 {
8568 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8569 lval = Qfullwidth;
8570 break;
8571 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8572 lval = Qfullheight;
8573 break;
8574 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8575 lval = Qfullboth;
8576 break;
8577 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8578 lval = Qmaximized;
8579 break;
8580 }
8581
8582 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8583 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8584 }
8585
8586 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8587 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8588 static void
8589 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8590 {
8591 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8592 return;
8593
8594 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8595 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8596
8597 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8598 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8599 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8600
8601 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8602 {
8603 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8604 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8605
8606 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8607 {
8608 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8609 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8610 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8611 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8612 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8613 break;
8614 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8615 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8616 break;
8617 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8618 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8619 }
8620
8621 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8622 width, height);
8623 }
8624 }
8625
8626 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8627 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8628 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8629 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8630 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8631 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8632 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8633
8634 static void
8635 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8636 {
8637 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8638
8639 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8640 window manager window around the frame. */
8641
8642 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8643
8644 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8645 {
8646 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8647
8648 int adjusted_left;
8649 int adjusted_top;
8650
8651 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8652 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8653 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8654
8655 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8656
8657 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8658 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8659
8660 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8661 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8662
8663 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8664 }
8665 else
8666 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8667 frame's position. */
8668
8669 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8670 }
8671
8672
8673 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8674 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8675 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8676 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8677 of an exact comparison. */
8678
8679 static void
8680 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8681 {
8682 int count = 0;
8683
8684 while (count++ < 50)
8685 {
8686 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8687
8688 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8689 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8690 loop. */
8691
8692 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8693 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8694
8695 if (fuzzy)
8696 {
8697 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8698 pixels. */
8699
8700 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8701 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8702 return;
8703 }
8704 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8705 return;
8706 }
8707
8708 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8709 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8710
8711 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8712 }
8713
8714
8715 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8716 void
8717 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8718 {
8719 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8720
8721 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8722 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8723 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8724
8725 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8726 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8727
8728 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticable.
8729 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8730 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (tmo, 0, 100000);
8731 EMACS_GET_TIME (tmo_at);
8732 EMACS_ADD_TIME (tmo_at, tmo_at, tmo);
8733
8734 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8735 {
8736 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
8737 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8738 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8739 BLOCK_INPUT;
8740 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8741
8742 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8743 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8744
8745 EMACS_GET_TIME (time_now);
8746 EMACS_SUB_TIME (tmo, tmo_at, time_now);
8747
8748 if (EMACS_TIME_NEG_P (tmo) || select (fd+1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo) == 0)
8749 break; /* Timeout */
8750 }
8751 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8752 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8753 }
8754
8755
8756 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8757 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8758 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8759 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8760
8761 static void
8762 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8763 {
8764 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8765
8766 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8767 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8768 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8769 ? 0
8770 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8771
8772 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8773
8774 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8775 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8776 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8777 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8778
8779 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8780 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8781 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8782 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8783
8784
8785 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8786 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8787 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8788 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8789 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8790
8791 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8792 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8793 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8794 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8795
8796 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8797 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8798 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8799 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8800 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8801
8802 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8803 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8804
8805 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8806 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8807 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8808 if (f->async_visible)
8809 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8810 else
8811 {
8812 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8813 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8814 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8815 x_sync (f);
8816 }
8817 }
8818
8819
8820 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8821 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8822 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8823 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8824
8825 void
8826 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8827 {
8828 BLOCK_INPUT;
8829
8830 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8831 {
8832 int r, c;
8833
8834 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8835 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8836 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8837 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8838 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8839 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8840 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8841 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8842 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8843 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8844 is however. */
8845 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8846 #endif
8847 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8848 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8849 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8850 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8851 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8852 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8853 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8854 }
8855
8856 #ifdef USE_GTK
8857 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8858 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8859 else
8860 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8861 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8862
8863 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8864
8865 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8866
8867 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8868 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8869
8870 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8871 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8872 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8873 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8874 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8875
8876 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8877 }
8878 \f
8879 /* Mouse warping. */
8880
8881 void
8882 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8883 {
8884 int pix_x, pix_y;
8885
8886 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8887 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8888
8889 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8890 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8891
8892 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8893 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8894
8895 BLOCK_INPUT;
8896
8897 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8898 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8899 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8900 }
8901
8902 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8903
8904 void
8905 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8906 {
8907 BLOCK_INPUT;
8908
8909 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8910 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8911 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8912 }
8913 \f
8914 /* Raise frame F. */
8915
8916 void
8917 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8918 {
8919 BLOCK_INPUT;
8920 if (f->async_visible)
8921 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8922
8923 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8924 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8925 }
8926
8927 /* Lower frame F. */
8928
8929 static void
8930 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8931 {
8932 if (f->async_visible)
8933 {
8934 BLOCK_INPUT;
8935 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8936 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8937 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8938 }
8939 }
8940
8941 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8942
8943 void
8944 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8945 {
8946 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8947 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8948
8949 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8950 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
8951 {
8952 Lisp_Object frame;
8953 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8954 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8955 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
8956 make_number (32),
8957 Fcons (make_number (1),
8958 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8959 Qnil)));
8960 }
8961 }
8962
8963 static void
8964 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
8965 {
8966 if (raise_flag)
8967 x_raise_frame (f);
8968 else
8969 x_lower_frame (f);
8970 }
8971 \f
8972 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8973
8974 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
8975
8976 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8977
8978 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
8979
8980 static void
8981 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
8982 {
8983 unsigned long data[2];
8984 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8985
8986 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
8987 data[1] = flags;
8988
8989 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8990 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
8991 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
8992 }
8993 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
8994
8995 static void
8996 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
8997 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
8998 {
8999 XEvent event;
9000
9001 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9002 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9003 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9004 event.xclient.format = 32;
9005 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9006 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9007 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9008 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9009 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9010
9011 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9012 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9013 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9014 }
9015 \f
9016 /* Change of visibility. */
9017
9018 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9019 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9020 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9021 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9022 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9023 finishes with it. */
9024
9025 void
9026 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9027 {
9028 Lisp_Object type;
9029 int original_top, original_left;
9030 int retry_count = 2;
9031
9032 retry:
9033
9034 BLOCK_INPUT;
9035
9036 type = x_icon_type (f);
9037 if (!NILP (type))
9038 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9039
9040 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9041 {
9042 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9043 call x_set_offset a second time
9044 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9045 before the window gets really visible. */
9046 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9047 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9048 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9049 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9050
9051 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9052
9053 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9054 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9055 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9056 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9057 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9058 else
9059 {
9060 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9061 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9062 }
9063 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9064 #ifdef USE_GTK
9065 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9066 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9067 #else
9068 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9069 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9070 else
9071 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9072 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9073 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9074 }
9075
9076 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9077
9078 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9079 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9080 so that incoming events are handled. */
9081 {
9082 Lisp_Object frame;
9083 int count;
9084 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9085 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9086 will set it when they are handled. */
9087 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9088
9089 original_left = f->left_pos;
9090 original_top = f->top_pos;
9091
9092 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9093 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9094
9095 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9096
9097 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9098 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9099 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9100 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9101
9102 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9103 because the window manager may choose the position
9104 and we don't want to override it. */
9105
9106 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9107 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9108 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9109 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9110 && previously_visible)
9111 {
9112 Drawable rootw;
9113 int x, y;
9114 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9115
9116 BLOCK_INPUT;
9117
9118 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9119 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9120 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9121 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9122 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9123 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9124 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9125 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9126 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9127
9128 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9129 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9130 original_left, original_top);
9131
9132 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9133 }
9134
9135 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9136
9137 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9138 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9139 MapNotify at all.. */
9140 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9141 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9142 {
9143 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9144 x_sync (f);
9145
9146 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9147 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9148 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9149 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9150 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9151 probably a bug. */
9152 if (input_polling_used ())
9153 {
9154 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9155 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9156 handler reset it. */
9157 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9158 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9159 poll_for_input_1 ();
9160 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9161 }
9162
9163 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9164 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9165 }
9166
9167 /* 2000-09-28: In
9168
9169 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9170 (iconify-frame f)
9171 (raise-frame f))
9172
9173 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9174 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9175 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9176 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9177
9178 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count != 0)
9179 goto retry;
9180 }
9181 }
9182
9183 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9184
9185 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9186
9187 void
9188 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9189 {
9190 Window window;
9191
9192 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9193 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9194
9195 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9196 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9197 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9198
9199 BLOCK_INPUT;
9200
9201 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9202 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9203 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9204 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9205 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9206 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9207
9208 #ifdef USE_GTK
9209 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9210 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9211 else
9212 #else
9213 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9214 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9215 else
9216 #endif
9217 {
9218
9219 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9220 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9221 {
9222 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9223 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9224 }
9225 }
9226
9227 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9228 just by the event that we get from the server.
9229 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9230 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9231 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9232 f->visible = 0;
9233 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9234 f->async_visible = 0;
9235 f->async_iconified = 0;
9236
9237 x_sync (f);
9238
9239 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9240 }
9241
9242 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9243
9244 void
9245 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9246 {
9247 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9248 int result;
9249 #endif
9250 Lisp_Object type;
9251
9252 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9253 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9254 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9255
9256 if (f->async_iconified)
9257 return;
9258
9259 BLOCK_INPUT;
9260
9261 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9262
9263 type = x_icon_type (f);
9264 if (!NILP (type))
9265 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9266
9267 #ifdef USE_GTK
9268 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9269 {
9270 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9271 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9272
9273 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9274 f->iconified = 1;
9275 f->visible = 1;
9276 f->async_iconified = 1;
9277 f->async_visible = 0;
9278 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9279 return;
9280 }
9281 #endif
9282
9283 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9284
9285 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9286 {
9287 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9288 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9289 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9290 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9291 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9292 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9293 so we have to record it here. */
9294 f->iconified = 1;
9295 f->visible = 1;
9296 f->async_iconified = 1;
9297 f->async_visible = 0;
9298 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9299 return;
9300 }
9301
9302 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9303 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9304 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9305 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9306
9307 if (!result)
9308 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9309
9310 f->async_iconified = 1;
9311 f->async_visible = 0;
9312
9313
9314 BLOCK_INPUT;
9315 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9316 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9317 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9318
9319 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9320 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9321 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9322 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9323 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9324 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9325
9326 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9327 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9328
9329 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9330 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9331 {
9332 XEvent msg;
9333
9334 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9335 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9336 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9337 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9338 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9339
9340 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9341 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9342 False,
9343 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9344 &msg))
9345 {
9346 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9347 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9348 }
9349 }
9350
9351 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9352 IconicState. */
9353 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9354
9355 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9356 {
9357 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9358 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9359 }
9360
9361 f->async_iconified = 1;
9362 f->async_visible = 0;
9363
9364 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9365 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9366 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9367 }
9368
9369 \f
9370 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9371
9372 void
9373 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9374 {
9375 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9376 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9377 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9378 Lisp_Object bar;
9379 struct scroll_bar *b;
9380 #endif
9381
9382 BLOCK_INPUT;
9383
9384 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9385 commands to the X server. */
9386 if (dpyinfo->display)
9387 {
9388 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9389 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9390 face. */
9391 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9392 free_frame_faces (f);
9393
9394 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9395 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9396
9397 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9398 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9399 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9400 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9401 toolkit scroll bars. */
9402 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9403 {
9404 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9405 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9406 }
9407 #endif
9408
9409 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9410 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9411 free_frame_xic (f);
9412 #endif
9413
9414 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9415 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9416 {
9417 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9418 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9419 }
9420 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9421 we are using a toolkit. */
9422 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9423 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9424
9425 free_frame_menubar (f);
9426 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9427
9428 #ifdef USE_GTK
9429 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9430 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9431
9432 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9433 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9434 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9435
9436 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9437 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9438 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9439 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9440 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9441 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9442
9443 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9444 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9445 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9446 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9447 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9448 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9449 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9450 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9451 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9452 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9453 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9454 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9455 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9456 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9457 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9458
9459 x_free_gcs (f);
9460 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9461 }
9462
9463 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9464 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9465 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9466
9467 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9468 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9469 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9470 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9471 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9472 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9473
9474 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9475 {
9476 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9477 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9478 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9479 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9480 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9481 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9482 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9483 }
9484
9485 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9486 }
9487
9488
9489 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9490
9491 static void
9492 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9493 {
9494 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9495
9496 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9497 commands to the X server. */
9498 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9499 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9500
9501 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9502 }
9503
9504 \f
9505 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9506
9507 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9508 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9509 that the window now has.
9510 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9511 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9512 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9513
9514 #ifndef USE_GTK
9515 void
9516 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, int user_position)
9517 {
9518 XSizeHints size_hints;
9519 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9520
9521 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9522 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9523
9524 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9525 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9526
9527 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9528 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9529
9530 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9531 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9532 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9533 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9534 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9535 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9536
9537 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9538 {
9539 int base_width, base_height;
9540 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9541
9542 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9543 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9544
9545 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9546
9547 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9548 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9549 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9550 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9551 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9552
9553 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9554 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9555 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9556
9557 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9558 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9559 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9560 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9561 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9562 }
9563
9564 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9565 if (flags)
9566 {
9567 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9568 goto no_read;
9569 }
9570
9571 {
9572 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9573 long supplied_return;
9574 int value;
9575
9576 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9577 &supplied_return);
9578
9579 if (flags)
9580 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9581 else
9582 {
9583 if (value == 0)
9584 hints.flags = 0;
9585 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9586 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9587 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9588 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9589 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9590 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9591 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9592 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9593 }
9594 }
9595
9596 no_read:
9597
9598 #ifdef PWinGravity
9599 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9600 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9601
9602 if (user_position)
9603 {
9604 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9605 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9606 }
9607 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9608
9609 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9610 }
9611 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9612
9613 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9614
9615 static void
9616 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9617 {
9618 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9619 Arg al[1];
9620
9621 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9622 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9623 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9624 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9625
9626 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9627 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9628
9629 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9630 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9631 }
9632
9633 static void
9634 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
9635 {
9636 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9637
9638 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9639 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9640 #endif
9641
9642 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9643 {
9644 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9645 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9646 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9647 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9648 }
9649 else
9650 {
9651 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9652 pixmap. */
9653 return;
9654 }
9655
9656
9657 #ifdef USE_GTK
9658 {
9659 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9660 return;
9661 }
9662
9663 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9664
9665 {
9666 Arg al[1];
9667 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9668 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9669 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9670 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9671 }
9672
9673 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9674
9675 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9676 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9677
9678 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9679 }
9680
9681 void
9682 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9683 {
9684 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9685
9686 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9687 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9688 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9689
9690 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9691 }
9692
9693 \f
9694 /***********************************************************************
9695 Fonts
9696 ***********************************************************************/
9697
9698 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9699
9700 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9701 font table. */
9702
9703 static void
9704 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9705 {
9706 xassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9707 if (font->driver->check)
9708 xassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9709 }
9710
9711 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9712
9713 \f
9714 /***********************************************************************
9715 Initialization
9716 ***********************************************************************/
9717
9718 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9719 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9720 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9721 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9722
9723 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9724 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9725 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9726
9727 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9728 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9729 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9730 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9731 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9732 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9733 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9734 };
9735
9736 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9737
9738 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9739
9740 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9741
9742 static int x_initialized;
9743
9744 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9745 the screen number from the server number. */
9746 static int
9747 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9748 {
9749 int seen_colon = 0;
9750 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9751 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
9752 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
9753
9754 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9755 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9756 length_until_period++;
9757
9758 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9759 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9760 name1 += 4;
9761 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9762 name2 += 4;
9763 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9764 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9765 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9766 name1 += system_name_length;
9767 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9768 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9769 name2 += system_name_length;
9770 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9771 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9772 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9773 name1 += length_until_period;
9774 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9775 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9776 name2 += length_until_period;
9777
9778 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9779 {
9780 if (*name1 == ':')
9781 seen_colon = 1;
9782 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9783 return 1;
9784 }
9785 return (seen_colon
9786 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9787 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9788 }
9789
9790 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9791 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9792 to 5. */
9793 static void
9794 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9795 {
9796 int nr = 0;
9797 int off = 0;
9798
9799 while (!(mask & 1))
9800 {
9801 off++;
9802 mask >>= 1;
9803 }
9804
9805 while (mask & 1)
9806 {
9807 nr++;
9808 mask >>= 1;
9809 }
9810
9811 *offset = off;
9812 *bits = nr;
9813 }
9814
9815 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9816 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9817
9818 int
9819 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9820 {
9821 int dpy_ok = 1;
9822 Display *dpy;
9823
9824 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9825 if (dpy)
9826 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9827 else
9828 dpy_ok = 0;
9829 return dpy_ok;
9830 }
9831
9832 #ifdef USE_GTK
9833 static void
9834 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9835 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9836 {
9837 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9838 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9839 }
9840 #endif
9841
9842 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9843 the structure that describes the open display.
9844 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9845
9846 struct x_display_info *
9847 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9848 {
9849 int connection;
9850 Display *dpy;
9851 struct terminal *terminal;
9852 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9853 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9854 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9855 ptrdiff_t lim;
9856
9857 BLOCK_INPUT;
9858
9859 if (!x_initialized)
9860 {
9861 x_initialize ();
9862 ++x_initialized;
9863 }
9864
9865 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9866 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9867
9868 #ifdef USE_GTK
9869 {
9870 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9871 int argc;
9872 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9873 char **argv2 = argv;
9874 guint id;
9875
9876 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9877 {
9878 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9879 }
9880 else
9881 {
9882 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9883 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9884
9885 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9886 argv[argc] = 0;
9887
9888 argc = 0;
9889 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9890
9891 if (! NILP (display_name))
9892 {
9893 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9894 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9895 }
9896
9897 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9898 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9899
9900 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9901
9902 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
9903 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
9904 {
9905 static char fix_events[] = "GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1";
9906 putenv (fix_events);
9907 }
9908
9909 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9910 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9911 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9912 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9913 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9914 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9915
9916 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
9917 fixup_locale ();
9918 xg_initialize ();
9919
9920 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
9921
9922 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
9923 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9924
9925 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
9926 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9927 {
9928 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9929 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9930
9931 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
9932 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9933
9934 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9935 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
9936 }
9937 #endif
9938
9939 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9940 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9941 }
9942 }
9943 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9944 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9945 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9946 errors with X11R5:
9947 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9948 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9949 So let's not use it until R6. */
9950 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9951 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9952 #endif
9953
9954 {
9955 int argc = 0;
9956 char *argv[3];
9957
9958 argv[0] = "";
9959 argc = 1;
9960 if (xrm_option)
9961 {
9962 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
9963 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
9964 }
9965 turn_on_atimers (0);
9966 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
9967 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9968 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
9969 &argc, argv);
9970 turn_on_atimers (1);
9971
9972 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9973 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9974 fixup_locale ();
9975 #endif
9976 }
9977
9978 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9979 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9980 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
9981 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9982 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
9983
9984 /* Detect failure. */
9985 if (dpy == 0)
9986 {
9987 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9988 return 0;
9989 }
9990
9991 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
9992
9993 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
9994 memset (dpyinfo, 0, sizeof *dpyinfo);
9995 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9996
9997 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
9998
9999 {
10000 struct x_display_info *share;
10001 Lisp_Object tail;
10002
10003 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10004 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10005 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10006 SSDATA (display_name)))
10007 break;
10008 if (share)
10009 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10010 else
10011 {
10012 terminal->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10013 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10014 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vwindow_system) = Qx;
10015
10016 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10017 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10018 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10019 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10020 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10021
10022 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10023 {
10024 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10025
10026 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10027 list of terminals. */
10028 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10029 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10030 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10031 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10032
10033 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10034 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10035 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10036 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vsystem_key_alist)
10037 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10038 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
10039 BLOCK_INPUT;
10040 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10041 terminal_list = terminal;
10042 UNGCPRO;
10043 }
10044
10045 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10046 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10047 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10048 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10049 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10050 }
10051 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10052 }
10053
10054 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10055 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10056 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10057
10058 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10059 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10060 x_display_name_list);
10061 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10062
10063 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10064
10065 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10066 terminal->name = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10067 strncpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10068 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10069
10070 #if 0
10071 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10072 #endif /* ! 0 */
10073
10074 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10075 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10076 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10077 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10078 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10079 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10080 + 2);
10081 strcat (strcat (strcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, SSDATA (Vinvocation_name)), "@"),
10082 SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10083
10084 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10085 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10086
10087 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10088 #ifdef USE_GTK
10089 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10090 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10091 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10092
10093 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10094 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10095
10096 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10097 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10098 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10099 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10100 #else
10101 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10102 #endif
10103 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10104 all versions. */
10105 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10106
10107 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10108 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10109 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10110 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10111 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10112 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10113 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10114 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10115 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10116 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10117 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10118 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10119 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10120 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10121 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10122 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10123 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10124 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10125 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10126 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10127 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10128 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10129 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10130 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10131 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10132 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10133 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10134 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10135
10136 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10137 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10138 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10139
10140 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10141 {
10142 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10143 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10144 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10145 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10146 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10147 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10148 }
10149
10150 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10151 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10152 {
10153 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10154 {
10155 Lisp_Object value;
10156 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10157 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10158 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10159 Qnil, Qnil);
10160 if (STRINGP (value)
10161 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10162 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10163 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10164 }
10165 }
10166 else
10167 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10168 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10169
10170 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10171 {
10172 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10173 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10174 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10175 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10176 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10177 for example). */
10178 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10179 double d;
10180 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10181 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10182 }
10183 #endif
10184
10185 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10186 {
10187 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10188 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10189 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10190 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10191 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10192 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10193 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10194 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10195 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10196 }
10197
10198 {
10199 const struct
10200 {
10201 const char *name;
10202 Atom *atom;
10203 } atom_refs[] = {
10204 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10205 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10206 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10207 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10208 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10209 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10210 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10211 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10212 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10213 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10214 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10215 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10216 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10217 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10218 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10219 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10220 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10221 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10222 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10223 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10224 { "ATOM", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM },
10225 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10226 { "CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER },
10227 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10228 /* For properties of font. */
10229 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10230 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10231 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10232 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10233 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10234 /* Ghostscript support. */
10235 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10236 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10237 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10238 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10239 /* EWMH */
10240 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10241 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10242 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10243 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10244 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10245 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10246 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10247 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10248 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10249 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10250 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10251 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10252 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10253 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10254 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10255 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10256 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10257 /* Session management */
10258 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10259 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10260 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10261 };
10262
10263 int i;
10264 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10265 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10266 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10267 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (sizeof (Atom) * total_atom_count);
10268 char **atom_names = xmalloc (sizeof (char *) * total_atom_count);
10269 char xsettings_atom_name[64];
10270
10271 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10272 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10273
10274 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10275 snprintf (xsettings_atom_name, sizeof (xsettings_atom_name),
10276 "_XSETTINGS_S%d", XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10277 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10278
10279 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10280 False, atoms_return);
10281
10282 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10283 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10284
10285 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10286 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10287
10288 xfree (atom_names);
10289 xfree (atoms_return);
10290 }
10291
10292 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10293 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10294 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
10295 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10296
10297 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10298 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10299 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10300
10301 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10302 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10303
10304 {
10305 dpyinfo->gray
10306 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10307 gray_bitmap_bits,
10308 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10309 1, 0, 1);
10310 }
10311
10312 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10313 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10314 #endif
10315
10316 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10317
10318 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10319 if (connection != 0)
10320 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10321
10322 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10323 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10324 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10325
10326 #ifdef SIGIO
10327 if (interrupt_input)
10328 init_sigio (connection);
10329 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10330
10331 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10332 {
10333 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10334 Font font;
10335
10336 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10337 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10338 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10339 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10340 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10341 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10342 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10343 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10344 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10345 abort ();
10346 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10347 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10348 x_uncatch_errors ();
10349 }
10350 #endif
10351
10352 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10353 for debugging X code. */
10354 {
10355 Lisp_Object value;
10356 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10357 build_string ("synchronous"),
10358 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10359 Qnil, Qnil);
10360 if (STRINGP (value)
10361 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10362 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10363 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10364 }
10365
10366 {
10367 Lisp_Object value;
10368 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10369 build_string ("useXIM"),
10370 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10371 Qnil, Qnil);
10372 #ifdef USE_XIM
10373 if (STRINGP (value)
10374 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10375 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10376 use_xim = 0;
10377 #else
10378 if (STRINGP (value)
10379 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10380 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10381 use_xim = 1;
10382 #endif
10383 }
10384
10385 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10386 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10387 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10388 tty. */
10389 if (terminal->id == 1)
10390 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10391 #endif
10392
10393 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10394
10395 return dpyinfo;
10396 }
10397 \f
10398 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10399 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10400
10401 static void
10402 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10403 {
10404 struct terminal *t;
10405
10406 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10407 X display. */
10408 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10409 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10410 {
10411 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10412 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10413 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10414 x_session_close ();
10415 #endif
10416 delete_terminal (t);
10417 break;
10418 }
10419
10420 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10421
10422 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10423 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10424 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10425 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10426 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10427 else
10428 {
10429 Lisp_Object tail;
10430
10431 tail = x_display_name_list;
10432 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10433 {
10434 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10435 {
10436 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10437 break;
10438 }
10439 tail = XCDR (tail);
10440 }
10441 }
10442
10443 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10444 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10445
10446 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10447 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10448 else
10449 {
10450 struct x_display_info *tail;
10451
10452 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10453 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10454 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10455 }
10456
10457 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10458 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10459 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10460 xfree (dpyinfo);
10461 }
10462
10463 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10464
10465 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10466 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10467 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10468 that slows us down. */
10469
10470 static void
10471 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10472 {
10473 BLOCK_INPUT;
10474 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10475 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10476 {
10477 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10478 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10479 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10480 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10481 }
10482 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10483 }
10484
10485 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10486 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10487 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10488 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10489 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10490 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10491 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10492
10493 void
10494 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10495 {
10496 BLOCK_INPUT;
10497 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10498 {
10499 EMACS_TIME interval;
10500
10501 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10502 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10503 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10504 }
10505 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10506 }
10507
10508 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10509
10510 \f
10511 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10512
10513 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10514
10515 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10516 {
10517 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10518 x_produce_glyphs,
10519 x_write_glyphs,
10520 x_insert_glyphs,
10521 x_clear_end_of_line,
10522 x_scroll_run,
10523 x_after_update_window_line,
10524 x_update_window_begin,
10525 x_update_window_end,
10526 x_cursor_to,
10527 x_flush,
10528 #ifdef XFlush
10529 x_flush,
10530 #else
10531 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10532 #endif
10533 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10534 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10535 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10536 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10537 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10538 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10539 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10540 x_draw_glyph_string,
10541 x_define_frame_cursor,
10542 x_clear_frame_area,
10543 x_draw_window_cursor,
10544 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10545 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10546 };
10547
10548
10549 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10550 void
10551 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10552 {
10553 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10554
10555 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10556 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10557 if (!terminal->name)
10558 return;
10559
10560 BLOCK_INPUT;
10561 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10562 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10563 X display. */
10564 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10565 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10566 #endif
10567
10568 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10569 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10570 if (dpyinfo->display)
10571 {
10572 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10573 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10574
10575 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10576 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10577 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10578 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10579
10580 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10581 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10582 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10583 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10584 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10585 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10586 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10587 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10588 leaks in other situations. */
10589 #if 0
10590 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10591 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10592 #else
10593 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10594 #endif
10595 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10596 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10597 closing all the displays. */
10598 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10599 #endif
10600
10601 #ifdef USE_GTK
10602 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10603 #else
10604 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10605 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10606 #else
10607 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10608 #endif
10609 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10610 }
10611
10612 /* Mark as dead. */
10613 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10614 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10615 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10616 }
10617
10618 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10619 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10620
10621 static struct terminal *
10622 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10623 {
10624 struct terminal *terminal;
10625
10626 terminal = create_terminal ();
10627
10628 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10629 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10630 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10631
10632 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10633
10634 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10635 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10636 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10637 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10638 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10639 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10640 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10641 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10642 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10643 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10644 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10645 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10646 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10647 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10648 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10649 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10650 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10651 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10652 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10653 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10654
10655 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10656 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10657
10658 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10659 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10660 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10661 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10662 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10663 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10664 off the bottom. */
10665
10666 return terminal;
10667 }
10668
10669 void
10670 x_initialize (void)
10671 {
10672 baud_rate = 19200;
10673
10674 x_noop_count = 0;
10675 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10676 any_help_event_p = 0;
10677 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10678
10679 #ifdef USE_GTK
10680 current_count = -1;
10681 #endif
10682
10683 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10684 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10685
10686 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10687 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10688
10689 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10690
10691 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10692 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10693 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10694 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10695 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10696 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10697 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10698
10699 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10700 #endif
10701
10702 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10703 #ifndef USE_GTK
10704 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10705 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10706 #endif
10707 #endif
10708
10709 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10710 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10711 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10712
10713 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10714 original error handler. */
10715 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10716 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10717
10718 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10719
10720 xgselect_initialize ();
10721 }
10722
10723
10724 void
10725 syms_of_xterm (void)
10726 {
10727 x_error_message = NULL;
10728
10729 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10730 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10731
10732 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10733 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10734
10735 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
10736 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
10737
10738 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10739 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10740
10741 #ifdef USE_GTK
10742 xg_default_icon_file = make_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10743 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10744
10745 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
10746 #endif
10747
10748 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10749 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10750 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10751 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10752 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10753 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10754 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10755 sizes. */);
10756 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10757
10758 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10759 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10760 doc: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10761 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10762 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10763 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10764 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10765
10766 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10767 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10768 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10769 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10770 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10771 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10772 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10773 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10774 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10775
10776 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10777 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10778 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10779 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10780 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10781 With MS Windows, the value is t. */);
10782 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10783 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10784 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10785 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10786 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10787 #elif USE_GTK
10788 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10789 #else
10790 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10791 #endif
10792 #else
10793 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10794 #endif
10795
10796 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10797 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10798
10799 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10800 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10801 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10802 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10803 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10804 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10805 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10806 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10807 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10808
10809 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10810 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10811 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10812 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10813 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10814 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10815
10816 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10817 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10818 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10819 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10820 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10821 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10822
10823 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10824 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10825 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10826 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10827 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10828 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10829
10830 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10831 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10832 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10833 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10834 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10835 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10836
10837 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10838 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10839 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10840 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10841 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10842 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10843 }
10844
10845 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */